10-Q
Table of Contents

 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
 
 
FORM 10-Q
 
     
x
  QUARTERLY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934.
     
    For the quarterly period ended June 26, 2009
 
or
     
o
  TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934.
     
    For the transition period from                        to
 
Commission File Number: 001-14965
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
     
Delaware   13-4019460
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  (I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
     
85 Broad Street, New York, NY   10004
(Address of principal executive offices)   (Zip Code)
 
(212) 902-1000
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.     x  Yes  o  No
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).     x  Yes  o  No
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
Large accelerated filer x      Accelerated filer o
 
Non-accelerated filer o (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)  Smaller reporting company o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).     o  Yes  x  No
 
APPLICABLE ONLY TO CORPORATE ISSUERS
 
As of July 24, 2009, there were 511,236,761 shares of the registrant’s common stock outstanding.
 


 

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC.
 
QUARTERLY REPORT ON FORM 10-Q FOR THE FISCAL QUARTER ENDED JUNE 26, 2009
 
INDEX
 
             
        Page
Form 10-Q Item Number:
 
No.
 
           
         
           
         
        2  
        3  
        4  
        5  
        6  
        7  
        76  
        77  
           
      81  
           
      139  
           
      139  
           
         
           
      140  
           
      142  
           
      143  
           
      144  
       
    145  
 EX-10.1: LETTER TO MR. JAMES J. SCHIRO
 EX-12.1:STATEMENT RE: COMPUTATION OF RATIONS OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES AND RATIOS TO COMBINED FIXED CHARGES AND PREFERRED STOCK DIVIDENDS
 EX-15.1:LETTER RE: UNAUDITED INTERIM FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 EX-31.1: RULE 13A-14(A) CERTIFICATIONS
 EX-32.1: SECTION 1350 CERTIFICATIONS
 EX-101 INSTANCE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 SCHEMA DOCUMENT
 EX-101 CALCULATION LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 LABELS LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 PRESENTATION LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 DEFINITION LINKBASE DOCUMENT


1


Table of Contents

 
PART I: FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
Item 1:   Financial Statements (Unaudited)
 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF EARNINGS
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions, except per share amounts)
 
Revenues
                               
Investment banking
  $ 1,440     $ 1,685     $ 2,263     $ 2,851  
Trading and principal investments
    9,322       5,239       15,028       10,116  
Asset management and securities services
    957       1,221       1,946       2,562  
                                 
Total non-interest revenues
    11,719       8,145       19,237       15,529  
                                 
Interest income
    3,470       9,498       7,832       20,743  
Interest expense
    1,428       8,221       3,883       18,515  
                                 
Net interest income
    2,042       1,277       3,949       2,228  
                                 
Net revenues, including net interest income
    13,761       9,422       23,186       17,757  
                                 
Operating expenses
                               
Compensation and benefits
    6,649       4,522       11,361       8,523  
                                 
Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees
    574       741       1,110       1,531  
Market development
    82       126       150       270  
Communications and technology
    173       192       346       379  
Depreciation and amortization
    426       220       975       474  
Occupancy
    242       234       483       470  
Professional fees
    145       185       280       363  
Other expenses
    441       370       823       772  
                                 
Total non-compensation expenses
    2,083       2,068       4,167       4,259  
                                 
Total operating expenses
    8,732       6,590       15,528       12,782  
                                 
                                 
Pre-tax earnings
    5,029       2,832       7,658       4,975  
Provision for taxes
    1,594       745       2,409       1,377  
                                 
Net earnings
    3,435       2,087       5,249       3,598  
Preferred stock dividends
    717       36       872       80  
                                 
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders
  $ 2,718     $ 2,051     $ 4,377     $ 3,518  
                                 
Earnings per common share
                               
Basic
  $ 5.27     $ 4.80     $ 8.81     $ 8.18  
Diluted
    4.93       4.58       8.42       7.81  
                                 
Dividends declared per common share
  $ 0.35     $ 0.35     $ 0.35     $ 0.70  
                                 
Average common shares outstanding
                               
Basic
    514.1       427.5       495.7       430.3  
Diluted
    551.0       447.4       520.1       450.6  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.


2


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
(UNAUDITED)
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions, except share
    and per share amounts)
 
Assets
               
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 22,177     $ 15,740  
Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes (includes $32,038 and $78,830 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    53,813       106,664  
Collateralized agreements:
               
Securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold (includes $138,339 and $116,671 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    138,339       122,021  
Securities borrowed (includes $87,018 and $59,810 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    218,544       180,795  
Receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
    21,934       25,899  
Receivables from customers and counterparties (includes $1,913 and $1,598 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    50,381       64,665  
Trading assets, at fair value (includes $31,135 and $26,313 pledged as collateral as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    355,251       338,325  
Other assets
    29,105       30,438  
                 
Total assets
  $ 889,544     $ 884,547  
                 
                 
Liabilities and shareholders’ equity
               
Deposits (includes $5,045 and $4,224 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
  $ 41,457     $ 27,643  
Collateralized financings:
               
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
    132,982       62,883  
Securities loaned (includes $12,194 and $7,872 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    20,289       17,060  
Other secured financings (includes $17,480 and $20,249 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    30,297       38,683  
Payables to brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
    11,028       8,585  
Payables to customers and counterparties
    185,353       245,258  
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    147,297       175,972  
Unsecured short-term borrowings, including the current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings (includes $14,920 and $23,075 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    35,173       52,658  
Unsecured long-term borrowings (includes $19,897 and $17,446 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    191,242       168,220  
Other liabilities and accrued expenses (includes $2,162 and $978 at fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively)
    31,613       23,216  
                 
Total liabilities
    826,731       820,178  
                 
Commitments, contingencies and guarantees
               
                 
Shareholders’ equity
               
Preferred stock, par value $0.01 per share; aggregate liquidation preference of $8,100 and $18,100 as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively
    6,957       16,471  
Common stock, par value $0.01 per share; 4,000,000,000 shares authorized, 749,041,990 and 680,953,836 shares issued as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, and 510,736,634 and 442,537,317 shares outstanding as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively
    7       7  
Restricted stock units and employee stock options
    5,187       9,284  
Nonvoting common stock, par value $0.01 per share; 200,000,000 shares authorized, no shares issued and outstanding
           
Additional paid-in capital
    40,342       31,071  
Retained earnings
    42,827       39,913  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
    (350 )     (202 )
Common stock held in treasury, at cost, par value $0.01 per share; 238,305,356 and 238,416,519 shares as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively
    (32,157 )     (32,175 )
                 
Total shareholders’ equity
    62,813       64,369  
                 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 889,544     $ 884,547  
                 
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.


3


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
(UNAUDITED)
 
                 
    Six Months
   
    Ended   Year Ended
    June 2009 (1)   November 2008
    (in millions)
 
Preferred stock
               
Balance, beginning of period
  $ 16,483     $ 3,100  
Issued
          13,367  
Accretion
    48       4  
Repurchased
    (9,574 )      
                 
Balance, end of period
    6,957       16,471  
Common stock
               
Balance, beginning of period
    7       6  
Issued
          1  
                 
Balance, end of period
    7       7  
Restricted stock units and employee stock options
               
Balance, beginning of period
    9,463       9,302  
Issuance and amortization of restricted stock units and employee stock options
    959       2,254  
Delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units
    (5,174 )     (1,995 )
Forfeiture of restricted stock units and employee stock options
    (60 )     (274 )
Exercise of employee stock options
    (1 )     (3 )
                 
Balance, end of period
    5,187       9,284  
Additional paid-in capital
               
Balance, beginning of period
    31,070       22,027  
Issuance of common stock
    5,750       5,750  
Issuance of common stock warrants
          1,633  
Delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units and proceeds from the exercise of employee stock options
    5,303       2,331  
Cancellation of restricted stock units in satisfaction of withholding tax requirements
    (849 )     (1,314 )
Preferred and common stock issuance costs
          (1 )
Excess net tax benefit/(provision) related to share-based compensation
    (930 )     645  
Cash settlement of share-based compensation
    (2 )      
                 
Balance, end of period
    40,342       31,071  
Retained earnings
               
Balance, beginning of period
    38,579       38,642  
Cumulative effect of adjustment from adoption of FIN 48
          (201 )
                 
Balance, beginning of period, after cumulative effect of adjustments
    38,579       38,441  
Net earnings
    5,249       2,322  
Dividends and dividend equivalents declared on common stock and restricted stock units
    (197 )     (642 )
Dividends declared on preferred stock
    (756 )     (204 )
Preferred stock accretion
    (48 )     (4 )
                 
Balance, end of period
    42,827       39,913  
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
               
Balance, beginning of period
    (372 )     (118 )
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
    (29 )     (98 )
Pension and postretirement liability adjustment, net of tax
    17       69  
Net unrealized gains/(losses) on available-for-sale securities, net of tax
    34       (55 )
                 
Balance, end of period
    (350 )     (202 )
Common stock held in treasury, at cost
               
Balance, beginning of period
    (32,176 )     (30,159 )
Repurchased
    (2 (2)     (2,037 )
Reissued
    21       21  
                 
Balance, end of period
    (32,157 )     (32,175 )
                 
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 62,813     $ 64,369  
                 
 
 
(1)  In connection with becoming a bank holding company, the firm was required to change its fiscal year-end from November to December. The beginning of period for the six months ended June 2009 is December 26, 2008.
 
(2)  Relates to repurchases of common stock by a broker-dealer subsidiary to facilitate customer transactions in the ordinary course of business and shares withheld to satisfy withholding tax requirements.
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.


4


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(UNAUDITED)
 
                 
    Six Months Ended
    June
  May
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
 
Cash flows from operating activities
               
Net earnings
  $ 5,249     $ 3,598  
Non-cash items included in net earnings
               
Depreciation and amortization
    1,176       654  
Share-based compensation
    907       894  
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
               
Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes
    58,895       35,265  
Net receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
    2,715       (1,485 )
Net payables to customers and counterparties
    (37,786 )     54,916  
Securities borrowed, net of securities loaned
    (16,490 )     (15,196 )
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, net of securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold
    (136,246 )     (89,500 )
Trading assets, at fair value
    172,389       28,881  
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    (38,731 )     (32,154 )
Other, net
    3,942       35  
                 
Net cash provided by/(used for) operating activities
    16,020       (14,092 )
Cash flows from investing activities
               
Purchase of property, leasehold improvements and equipment
    (653 )     (1,033 )
Proceeds from sales of property, leasehold improvements and equipment
    50       55  
Business acquisitions, net of cash acquired
    (208 )     (2,199 )
Proceeds from sales of investments
    140       80  
Purchase of available-for-sale securities
    (1,904 )     (2,556 )
Proceeds from sales of available-for-sale securities
    1,803       2,090  
                 
Net cash used for investing activities
    (772 )     (3,563 )
Cash flows from financing activities
               
Unsecured short-term borrowings, net
    (10,965 )     (7,286 )
Other secured financings (short-term), net
    (6,531 )     (8,341 )
Proceeds from issuance of other secured financings (long-term)
    3,400       5,014  
Repayment of other secured financings (long-term), including the current portion
    (2,850 )     (3,648 )
Proceeds from issuance of unsecured long-term borrowings
    20,875       31,790  
Repayment of unsecured long-term borrowings, including the current portion
    (16,805 )     (11,751 )
Preferred stock repurchased
    (9,574 )      
Derivative contracts with a financing element, net
    1,815       155  
Deposits, net
    9,327       14,148  
Common stock repurchased
    (2 )     (1,761 )
Dividends and dividend equivalents paid on common stock, preferred stock and restricted stock units
    (1,495 )     (393 )
Proceeds from issuance of common stock, including stock option exercises
    5,893       170  
Excess tax benefit related to share-based compensation
    38       582  
Cash settlement of share-based compensation
    (2 )      
                 
Net cash provided by/(used for) financing activities
    (6,876 )     18,679  
                 
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
    8,372       1,024  
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period
    13,805       10,282  
                 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period
  $ 22,177     $ 11,306  
                 
 
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES:
 
Cash payments for interest, net of capitalized interest, were $4.58 billion and $18.68 billion during the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively.
 
Cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, were $1.81 billion and $1.39 billion during the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively.
 
Non-cash activities:
The firm assumed $16 million and $610 million of debt in connection with business acquisitions during the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively.
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.


5


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
 
Net earnings
  $ 3,435     $ 2,087     $ 5,249     $ 3,598  
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
    (54 )     (21 )     (29 )     (12 )
Pension and postretirement liability adjustment, net of tax
    8       6       17       6  
Net unrealized gains/(losses) on available-for-sale securities, net of tax
    53       23       34       (12 )
                                 
Comprehensive income
  $ 3,442     $ 2,095     $ 5,271     $ 3,580  
                                 
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.


6


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(UNAUDITED)
 
Note 1.   Description of Business
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc.), a Delaware corporation, together with its consolidated subsidiaries (collectively, the firm), is a leading global financial services firm providing investment banking, securities and investment management services to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments and high-net-worth individuals. Founded in 1869, the firm is headquartered in New York and maintains offices in London, Frankfurt, Tokyo, Hong Kong and other major financial centers around the world.
 
The firm’s activities are divided into three segments:
 
  •  Investment Banking.  The firm provides a broad range of investment banking services to a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals.
 
  •  Trading and Principal Investments.  The firm facilitates client transactions with a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals and takes proprietary positions through market making in, trading of and investing in fixed income and equity products, currencies, commodities and derivatives on these products. In addition, the firm engages in market-making and specialist activities on equities and options exchanges, and the firm clears client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide. In connection with the firm’s merchant banking and other investing activities, the firm makes principal investments directly and through funds that the firm raises and manages.
 
  •  Asset Management and Securities Services.  The firm provides investment advisory and financial planning services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and provides prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and to high-net-worth individuals worldwide.
 
Note 2.   Significant Accounting Policies
 
Basis of Presentation
 
These condensed consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Group Inc. and all other entities in which the firm has a controlling financial interest. All material intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated.
 
The firm determines whether it has a controlling financial interest in an entity by first evaluating whether the entity is a voting interest entity, a variable interest entity (VIE) or a qualifying special-purpose entity (QSPE) under generally accepted accounting principles.
 
  •  Voting Interest Entities.  Voting interest entities are entities in which (i) the total equity investment at risk is sufficient to enable the entity to finance its activities independently and (ii) the equity holders have the obligation to absorb losses, the right to receive residual returns and the right to make decisions about the entity’s activities. Voting interest entities are consolidated in accordance with Accounting Research Bulletin (ARB) No. 51, “Consolidated Financial Statements,” as amended. The usual condition for a controlling financial interest in an entity is ownership of a majority voting interest. Accordingly, the firm consolidates voting interest entities in which it has a majority voting interest.


7


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
  •  Variable Interest Entities.  VIEs are entities that lack one or more of the characteristics of a voting interest entity. A controlling financial interest in a VIE is present when an enterprise has a variable interest, or a combination of variable interests, that will absorb a majority of the VIE’s expected losses, receive a majority of the VIE’s expected residual returns, or both. The enterprise with a controlling financial interest, known as the primary beneficiary, consolidates the VIE. In accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) Interpretation (FIN) 46-R, “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities,” the firm determines whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE by first performing a qualitative analysis of the VIE’s expected losses and expected residual returns. This analysis includes a review of, among other factors, the VIE’s capital structure, contractual terms, which interests create or absorb variability, related party relationships and the design of the VIE. Where qualitative analysis is not conclusive, the firm performs a quantitative analysis. For purposes of allocating a VIE’s expected losses and expected residual returns to its variable interest holders, the firm utilizes the “top down” method. Under this method, the firm calculates its share of the VIE’s expected losses and expected residual returns using the specific cash flows that would be allocated to it, based on contractual arrangements and/or the firm’s position in the capital structure of the VIE, under various probability-weighted scenarios. The firm reassesses its initial evaluation of an entity as a VIE and its initial determination of whether the firm is the primary beneficiary of a VIE upon the occurrence of certain reconsideration events as defined in FIN 46-R. See “— Recent Accounting Developments” below for information regarding amendments to FIN 46-R.
 
  •  QSPEs.  QSPEs are passive entities that are commonly used in mortgage and other securitization transactions. Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 140, “Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities,” sets forth the criteria an entity must satisfy to be a QSPE. These criteria include the types of assets a QSPE may hold, limits on asset sales, the use of derivatives and financial guarantees, and the level of discretion a servicer may exercise in attempting to collect receivables. These criteria may require management to make judgments about complex matters, such as whether a derivative is considered passive and the level of discretion a servicer may exercise, including, for example, determining when default is reasonably foreseeable. In accordance with SFAS No. 140 and FIN 46-R, the firm does not consolidate QSPEs. See “— Recent Accounting Developments” below for information regarding amendments to SFAS No. 140.
 
  •  Equity-Method Investments.  When the firm does not have a controlling financial interest in an entity but exerts significant influence over the entity’s operating and financial policies (generally defined as owning a voting interest of 20% to 50%) and has an investment in common stock or in-substance common stock, the firm accounts for its investment either in accordance with Accounting Principles Board Opinion (APB) No. 18, “The Equity Method of Accounting for Investments in Common Stock” or at fair value in accordance with SFAS No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities.” In general, the firm accounts for investments acquired subsequent to the adoption of SFAS No. 159 at fair value. In certain cases, the firm may apply the equity method of accounting to new investments that are strategic in nature or closely related to the firm’s principal business activities, where the firm has a significant degree of involvement in the cash flows or operations of the investee, or where cost-benefit considerations are less significant. See “— Revenue Recognition — Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value” below for a discussion of the firm’s application of SFAS No. 159.


8


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
  •  Other.  If the firm does not consolidate an entity or apply the equity method of accounting, the firm accounts for its investment at fair value. The firm also has formed numerous nonconsolidated investment funds with third-party investors that are typically organized as limited partnerships. The firm acts as general partner for these funds and generally does not hold a majority of the economic interests in these funds. The firm has generally provided the third-party investors with rights to terminate the funds or to remove the firm as the general partner. As a result, the firm does not consolidate these funds. These fund investments are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
These condensed consolidated financial statements are unaudited and should be read in conjunction with the audited consolidated financial statements included in the firm’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008. The condensed consolidated financial information as of November 28, 2008 has been derived from audited consolidated financial statements not included herein.
 
These unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements reflect all adjustments that are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of the results for the interim periods presented. These adjustments are of a normal, recurring nature. Interim period operating results may not be indicative of the operating results for a full year.
 
In connection with becoming a bank holding company, the firm was required to change its fiscal year-end from November to December. This change in the firm’s fiscal year-end resulted in a one-month transition period that began on November 29, 2008 and ended on December 26, 2008. The firm’s financial information for this fiscal transition period is included in the firm’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 27, 2009. On April 13, 2009, the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (the Board) approved a change in the firm’s fiscal year-end from the last Friday of December to December 31, beginning with fiscal 2009. Fiscal 2009 began on December 27, 2008 and will end on December 31, 2009. The firm’s third fiscal quarter in 2009 will end on the last Friday of September. Beginning in the fourth quarter of 2009, the firm’s fiscal year will end on December 31.
 
In the condensed consolidated statements of earnings, cash flows and comprehensive income, the firm compares the three and six month periods, as applicable, ended June 26, 2009 with the previously reported three and six month periods ended May 30, 2008. Financial information for the three and six months ended June 27, 2008 has not been included in this Form 10-Q for the following reasons: (i) the three and six months ended May 30, 2008 provide a meaningful comparison for the three and six months ended June 26, 2009; (ii) there are no significant factors, seasonal or other, that would impact the comparability of information if the results for the three and six months ended June 27, 2008 were presented in lieu of results for the three and six months ended May 30, 2008; and (iii) it was not practicable or cost justified to prepare this information.
 
All references to June 2009 and May 2008, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to the firm’s three-month fiscal periods ended, or the dates, as the context requires, June 26, 2009 and May 30, 2008, respectively. All references to November 2008, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to the firm’s fiscal year ended, or the date, as the context requires, November 28, 2008. All references to 2009, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to the firm’s fiscal year ending, or the date, as the context requires, December 31, 2009. Certain reclassifications have been made to previously reported amounts to conform to the current presentation.


9


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Use of Estimates
 
These condensed consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles that require management to make certain estimates and assumptions. The most important of these estimates and assumptions relate to fair value measurements, the accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, discretionary compensation accruals and the provision for potential losses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings and tax audits. Although these and other estimates and assumptions are based on the best available information, actual results could be materially different from these estimates.
 
Revenue Recognition
 
Investment Banking.  Underwriting revenues and fees from mergers and acquisitions and other financial advisory assignments are recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings when the services related to the underlying transaction are completed under the terms of the engagement. Expenses associated with such transactions are deferred until the related revenue is recognized or the engagement is otherwise concluded. Underwriting revenues are presented net of related expenses. Expenses associated with financial advisory transactions are recorded as non-compensation expenses, net of client reimbursements.
 
Trading Assets and Trading Liabilities.  Substantially all trading assets and trading liabilities are reflected in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value, pursuant principally to:
 
  •  SFAS No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities;”
 
  •  specialized industry accounting for broker-dealers and investment companies;
 
  •  SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities;” or
 
  •  the fair value option under either SFAS No. 155, “Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments — an amendment of FASB Statements No. 133 and 140,” or SFAS No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities,” (i.e., the fair value option).
 
Related unrealized gains or losses are generally recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value.  In addition to “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value,” the firm has elected to account for certain of its other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value under the fair value option. The primary reasons for electing the fair value option are to reflect economic events in earnings on a timely basis, to mitigate volatility in earnings from using different measurement attributes and to address simplification and cost-benefit considerations.
 
Such financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value include:
 
  •  certain unsecured short-term borrowings, consisting of all promissory notes and commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  •  certain other secured financings, primarily transfers accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140, debt raised through the firm’s William Street program and certain other nonrecourse financings;


10


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
  •  certain unsecured long-term borrowings, including prepaid physical commodity transactions and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  •  resale and repurchase agreements;
 
  •  securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, consisting of the firm’s matched book and certain firm financing activities;
 
  •  certain deposits issued by Goldman Sachs Bank USA (GS Bank USA), as well as securities held by GS Bank USA;
 
  •  certain receivables from customers and counterparties, including certain margin loans, transfers accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases under SFAS No. 140 and prepaid variable share forwards;
 
  •  certain insurance and reinsurance contracts and certain guarantees; and
 
  •  in general, investments acquired after the adoption of SFAS No. 159 where the firm has significant influence over the investee and would otherwise apply the equity method of accounting.
 
Fair Value Measurements.  The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e., the exit price). Financial assets are marked to bid prices and financial liabilities are marked to offer prices. Fair value measurements do not include transaction costs.
 
SFAS No. 157, “Fair Value Measurements,” establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (level 3 measurements). The three levels of the fair value hierarchy under SFAS No. 157 are described below:
 
Basis of Fair Value Measurement
 
  Level 1   Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities;
 
  Level 2   Quoted prices in markets that are not considered to be active or financial instruments for which all significant inputs are observable, either directly or indirectly;
 
  Level 3   Prices or valuations that require inputs that are both significant to the fair value measurement and unobservable.
 
A financial instrument’s level within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement.
 
The firm defines active markets for equity instruments based on the average daily trading volume both in absolute terms and relative to the market capitalization for the instrument. The firm defines active markets for debt instruments based on both the average daily trading volume and the number of days with trading activity.
 
In October 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) No. FAS 157-3, “Determining the Fair Value of a Financial Asset When the Market for That Asset Is Not Active,” which specifies that it is acceptable to use inputs based on management estimates or assumptions, or for management to make adjustments to observable inputs, to determine fair value when markets are not active and


11


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
relevant observable inputs are not available. In April 2009, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 157-4, “Determining Fair Value When the Volume and Level of Activity for the Asset or Liability Have Significantly Decreased and Identifying Transactions That Are Not Orderly,” which provides additional guidance for estimating fair value when the volume and level of activity for an asset or liability have decreased significantly. The firm’s fair value measurement policies are consistent with the guidance in both FSP No. FAS 157-3 and FSP No. FAS 157-4. See “— Recent Accounting Developments” below for further information regarding FSP No. FAS 157-4.
 
Credit risk is an essential component of fair value. Cash products (e.g., bonds and loans) and derivative instruments (particularly those with significant future projected cash flows) trade in the market at levels which reflect credit considerations. The firm calculates the fair value of derivative assets by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates counterparty credit spreads and the fair value of derivative liabilities by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates the firm’s own credit spreads. In doing so, credit exposures are adjusted to reflect mitigants, namely collateral agreements which reduce exposures based on triggers and contractual posting requirements. The firm manages its exposure to credit risk as it does other market risks and will price, economically hedge, facilitate and intermediate trades which involve credit risk. The firm records liquidity valuation adjustments to reflect the cost of exiting concentrated risk positions, including exposure to the firm’s own credit spreads.
 
In determining fair value, the firm separates its “Trading assets, at fair value” and its “Trading liabilities, at fair value” into two categories: cash instruments and derivative contracts.
 
  •  Cash Instruments.  The firm’s cash instruments are generally classified within level 1 or level 2 of the fair value hierarchy because they are valued using quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. The types of instruments valued based on quoted market prices in active markets include most government obligations, active listed equities and certain money market securities. Such instruments are generally classified within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. In accordance with SFAS No. 157, the firm does not adjust the quoted price for such instruments, even in situations where the firm holds a large position and a sale could reasonably impact the quoted price.
 
The types of instruments that trade in markets that are not considered to be active, but are valued based on quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency include most government agency securities, investment-grade corporate bonds, certain mortgage products, certain bank loans and bridge loans, less liquid listed equities, certain state, municipal and provincial obligations and certain money market securities and loan commitments. Such instruments are generally classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
Certain cash instruments are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy because they trade infrequently and therefore have little or no price transparency. Such instruments include private equity and real estate fund investments, certain bank loans and bridge loans (including certain mezzanine financing, leveraged loans arising from capital market transactions and other corporate bank debt), less liquid corporate debt securities and other debt obligations (including less liquid high-yield corporate bonds, distressed debt instruments and collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) backed by corporate obligations), less liquid mortgage whole loans and securities (backed by either commercial or residential real estate), and acquired portfolios of distressed loans. The transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted


12


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. This valuation is adjusted only when changes to inputs and assumptions are corroborated by evidence such as transactions in similar instruments, completed or pending third-party transactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.
 
For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidity and/or non-transferability. Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Management’s judgment is required to determine the appropriate risk-adjusted discount rate for cash trading instruments that are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy and that have little or no price transparency as a result of decreased volumes and lower levels of trading activity. In such situations, the firm’s valuation is adjusted to approximate rates which market participants would likely consider appropriate for relevant credit and liquidity risks.
 
  •  Derivative Contracts.  Derivative contracts can be exchange-traded or over-the-counter (OTC). Exchange-traded derivatives typically fall within level 1 or level 2 of the fair value hierarchy depending on whether they are deemed to be actively traded or not. The firm generally values exchange-traded derivatives using models which calibrate to market-clearing levels and eliminate timing differences between the closing price of the exchange-traded derivatives and their underlying instruments. In such cases, exchange-traded derivatives are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
OTC derivatives are valued using market transactions and other market evidence whenever possible, including market-based inputs to models, model calibration to market-clearing transactions, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Where models are used, the selection of a particular model to value an OTC derivative depends upon the contractual terms of, and specific risks inherent in, the instrument, as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. The firm generally uses similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, credit curves, measures of volatility, prepayment rates and correlations of such inputs. For OTC derivatives that trade in liquid markets, such as generic forwards, swaps and options, model inputs can generally be verified and model selection does not involve significant management judgment. OTC derivatives are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy when all of the significant inputs can be corroborated to market evidence.
 
Certain OTC derivatives trade in less liquid markets with limited pricing information, and the determination of fair value for these derivatives is inherently more difficult. Such instruments are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Where the firm does not have corroborating market evidence to support significant model inputs and cannot verify the model to market transactions, the transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. The valuations of these less liquid OTC derivatives are typically based on level 1 and/or level 2 inputs that can be observed in the market, as well as unobservable level 3 inputs. Subsequent to initial recognition, the firm updates the level 1 and level 2 inputs to reflect observable market changes, with resulting gains and losses reflected within level 3. Level 3 inputs are only changed when corroborated


13


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
by evidence such as similar market transactions, third-party pricing services and/or broker or dealer quotations, or other empirical market data. In circumstances where the firm cannot verify the model value to market transactions, it is possible that a different valuation model could produce a materially different estimate of fair value.
 
When appropriate, valuations are adjusted for various factors such as liquidity, bid/offer spreads and credit considerations. Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Collateralized Agreements and Financings.  Collateralized agreements consist of resale agreements and securities borrowed. Collateralized financings consist of repurchase agreements, securities loaned and other secured financings. Interest on collateralized agreements and collateralized financings is recognized in “Interest income” and “Interest expense,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings over the life of the transaction.
 
  •  Resale and Repurchase Agreements.  Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, principally U.S. government, federal agency and investment-grade sovereign obligations, represent collateralized financing transactions. The firm receives securities purchased under agreements to resell, makes delivery of securities sold under agreements to repurchase, monitors the market value of these securities on a daily basis and delivers or obtains additional collateral as appropriate. As noted above, resale and repurchase agreements are carried in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value under SFAS No. 159. Resale and repurchase agreements are generally valued based on inputs with reasonable levels of price transparency and are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Resale and repurchase agreements are presented on a net-by-counterparty basis when the requirements of FIN 41, “Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Repurchase and Reverse Repurchase Agreements,” or FIN 39, “Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Contracts,” are satisfied.
 
  •  Securities Borrowed and Loaned.  Securities borrowed and loaned are generally collateralized by cash, securities or letters of credit. The firm receives securities borrowed, makes delivery of securities loaned, monitors the market value of securities borrowed and loaned, and delivers or obtains additional collateral as appropriate. Securities borrowed and loaned within Securities Services, relating to both customer activities and, to a lesser extent, certain firm financing activities, are recorded based on the amount of cash collateral advanced or received plus accrued interest. As these arrangements generally can be terminated on demand, they exhibit little, if any, sensitivity to changes in interest rates. As noted above, securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, which are related to the firm’s matched book and certain firm financing activities, are recorded at fair value under SFAS No. 159. These securities borrowed and loaned transactions are generally valued based on inputs with reasonable levels of price transparency and are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
  •  Other Secured Financings.  In addition to repurchase agreements and securities loaned, the firm funds assets through the use of other secured financing arrangements and pledges financial instruments and other assets as collateral in these transactions. As noted above, the firm has elected to apply SFAS No. 159 to transfers accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140, debt raised through the firm’s William Street program and certain other nonrecourse financings, for which the use of fair value eliminates non-economic volatility in earnings that would arise from using different measurement attributes. These other secured financing transactions are generally classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Other


14


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
  secured financings that are not recorded at fair value are recorded based on the amount of cash received plus accrued interest. See Note 3 for further information regarding other secured financings.
 
Hybrid Financial Instruments.  Hybrid financial instruments are instruments that contain bifurcatable embedded derivatives under SFAS No. 133 and do not require settlement by physical delivery of non-financial assets (e.g., physical commodities). If the firm elects to bifurcate the embedded derivative, it is accounted for at fair value and the host contract is accounted for at amortized cost, adjusted for the effective portion of any fair value hedge accounting relationships. If the firm does not elect to bifurcate, the entire hybrid financial instrument is accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155. See Notes 3 and 6 for further information regarding hybrid financial instruments.
 
Transfers of Financial Assets.  In general, transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales under SFAS No. 140 when the firm has relinquished control over the transferred assets. For transfers accounted for as sales, any related gains or losses are recognized in net revenues. Transfers that are not accounted for as sales are accounted for as collateralized financings, with the related interest expense recognized in net revenues over the life of the transaction.
 
Commissions.  Commission revenues from executing and clearing client transactions on stock, options and futures markets are recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings on a trade-date basis.
 
Insurance Activities.  Certain of the firm’s insurance and reinsurance contracts are accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159, with changes in fair value included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Revenues from variable annuity and life insurance and reinsurance contracts not accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159 generally consist of fees assessed on contract holder account balances for mortality charges, policy administration fees and surrender charges, and are recognized within “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings in the period that services are provided.
 
Interest credited to variable annuity and life insurance and reinsurance contract account balances and changes in reserves are recognized in “Other expenses” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Premiums earned for underwriting property catastrophe reinsurance are recognized within “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings over the coverage period, net of premiums ceded for the cost of reinsurance. Expenses for liabilities related to property catastrophe reinsurance claims, including estimates of losses that have been incurred but not reported, are recognized within “Other expenses” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Merchant Banking Overrides.  The firm is entitled to receive merchant banking overrides (i.e., an increased share of a fund’s income and gains) when the return on the funds’ investments exceeds certain threshold returns. Overrides are based on investment performance over the life of each merchant banking fund, and future investment underperformance may require amounts of override previously distributed to the firm to be returned to the funds. Accordingly, overrides are recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings only when all material contingencies have been resolved. Overrides are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.


15


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Asset Management.  Management fees are recognized over the period that the related service is provided based upon average net asset values. In certain circumstances, the firm is also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s return or when the return on assets under management exceeds specified benchmark returns or other performance targets. Incentive fees are generally based on investment performance over a 12-month period and are subject to adjustment prior to the end of the measurement period. Accordingly, incentive fees are recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings when the measurement period ends. Asset management fees and incentive fees are included in “Asset management and securities services” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Share-Based Compensation
 
The firm accounts for share-based compensation in accordance with SFAS No. 123-R, “Share-Based Payment.” The cost of employee services received in exchange for a share-based award is generally measured based on the grant-date fair value of the award. Share-based awards that do not require future service (i.e., vested awards, including awards granted to retirement-eligible employees) are expensed immediately. Share-based employee awards that require future service are amortized over the relevant service period. Expected forfeitures are included in determining share-based employee compensation expense. In the first quarter of 2006, the firm adopted SFAS No. 123-R under the modified prospective adoption method. Under this method of adoption, the provisions of SFAS No. 123-R are generally applied only to share-based awards granted subsequent to adoption. Share-based awards held by employees that were retirement-eligible on the date of adoption of SFAS No. 123-R continue to be amortized over the stated service period of the award.
 
The firm pays cash dividend equivalents on outstanding restricted stock units. Dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units are generally charged to retained earnings. Dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units expected to be forfeited are included in compensation expense. The firm adopted Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 06-11, “Accounting for Income Tax Benefits of Dividends on Share-Based Payment Awards” in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. Accordingly, the tax benefit related to dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units is accounted for as an increase to additional paid-in capital. Prior to the adoption of EITF Issue No. 06-11, the firm accounted for this tax benefit as a reduction to income tax expense. See “— Recent Accounting Developments” below for further information on EITF Issue No. 06-11.
 
In certain cases, primarily related to the death of an employee or conflicted employment (as outlined in the applicable award agreements), the firm may cash settle share-based compensation awards. For awards accounted for as equity instruments, additional paid-in capital is adjusted to the extent of the difference between the current value of the award and the grant-date value of the award.
 
Goodwill
 
Goodwill is the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition date. In accordance with SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets,” goodwill is tested at least annually for impairment. An impairment loss is recognized if the estimated fair value of an operating segment, which is a component one level below the firm’s three business segments, is less than its estimated net book value. Such loss is calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value of goodwill and its carrying value.


16


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
Identifiable intangible assets, which consist primarily of customer lists, Designated Market Maker (DMM) rights and the value of business acquired (VOBA) in the firm’s insurance subsidiaries, are amortized over their estimated lives in accordance with SFAS No. 142 or, in the case of insurance contracts, in accordance with SFAS No. 60, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises,” and SFAS No. 97, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for Certain Long-Duration Contracts and for Realized Gains and Losses from the Sale of Investments.” Identifiable intangible assets are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable in accordance with SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets,” or SFAS No. 60 and SFAS No. 97. An impairment loss, generally calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.
 
Property, Leasehold Improvements and Equipment
 
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization, are recorded at cost and included in “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Substantially all property and equipment are depreciated on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the asset. Leasehold improvements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the improvement or the term of the lease, whichever is shorter. Certain costs of software developed or obtained for internal use are capitalized and amortized on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the software.
 
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable in accordance with SFAS No. 144. An impairment loss, calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the expected undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.
 
The firm’s operating leases include office space held in excess of current requirements. Rent expense relating to space held for growth is included in “Occupancy” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. In accordance with SFAS No. 146, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities,” the firm records a liability, based on the fair value of the remaining lease rentals reduced by any potential or existing sublease rentals, for leases where the firm has ceased using the space and management has concluded that the firm will not derive any future economic benefits. Costs to terminate a lease before the end of its term are recognized and measured at fair value upon termination.
 
Foreign Currency Translation
 
Assets and liabilities denominated in non-U.S. currencies are translated at rates of exchange prevailing on the date of the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, and revenues and expenses are translated at average rates of exchange for the period. Gains or losses on translation of the financial statements of a non-U.S. operation, when the functional currency is other than the U.S. dollar, are included, net of hedges and taxes, in the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income. The firm seeks to reduce its net investment exposure to fluctuations in


17


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
foreign exchange rates through the use of foreign currency forward contracts and foreign currency-denominated debt. For foreign currency forward contracts, hedge effectiveness is assessed based on changes in forward exchange rates; accordingly, forward points are reflected as a component of the currency translation adjustment in the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income. For foreign currency-denominated debt, hedge effectiveness is assessed based on changes in spot rates. Foreign currency remeasurement gains or losses on transactions in nonfunctional currencies are included in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Income Taxes
 
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of the firm’s assets and liabilities. Valuation allowances are established to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount that more likely than not will be realized. The firm’s tax assets and liabilities are presented as a component of “Other assets” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. Tax provisions are computed in accordance with SFAS No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes.” The firm adopted the provisions of FIN 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes — an Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109,” as of December 1, 2007, and recorded a transition adjustment resulting in a reduction of $201 million to beginning retained earnings in the first fiscal quarter of 2008. Under FIN 48, a tax position can be recognized in the financial statements only when it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained upon examination by the relevant taxing authority based on the technical merits of the position. A position that meets this standard is measured at the largest amount of benefit that will more likely than not be realized upon settlement. A liability is established for differences between positions taken in a tax return and amounts recognized in the financial statements. The firm reports interest expense related to income tax matters in “Provision for taxes” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings and income tax penalties in “Other expenses” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Earnings Per Common Share (EPS)
 
Basic EPS is calculated by dividing net earnings applicable to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding. Common shares outstanding includes common stock and restricted stock units for which no future service is required as a condition to the delivery of the underlying common stock. Diluted EPS includes the determinants of basic EPS and, in addition, reflects the dilutive effect of the common stock deliverable pursuant to stock warrants and options and to restricted stock units for which future service is required as a condition to the delivery of the underlying common stock. The firm adopted FSP No. EITF 03-6-1, “Determining Whether Instruments Granted in Share-Based Payment Transactions Are Participating Securities,” in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. Accordingly, the firm treats unvested share-based payment awards that have non-forfeitable rights to dividend or dividend equivalents as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share. See “— Recent Accounting Developments” below for further information on FSP No. EITF 03-6-1.
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
The firm defines cash equivalents as highly liquid overnight deposits held in the ordinary course of business. As of June 2009 and November 2008, “Cash and cash equivalents” on the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition included $6.02 billion and $5.60 billion, respectively, of cash and due from banks and $16.16 billion and $10.14 billion, respectively, of interest-bearing deposits with banks.


18


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Recent Accounting Developments
 
EITF Issue No. 06-11.  In June 2007, the EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 06-11, “Accounting for Income Tax Benefits of Dividends on Share-Based Payment Awards.” EITF Issue No. 06-11 requires that the tax benefit related to dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units, which are expected to vest, be recorded as an increase to additional paid-in capital. The firm previously accounted for this tax benefit as a reduction to income tax expense. EITF Issue No. 06-11 was applied prospectively for tax benefits on dividend equivalents declared beginning in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. The adoption of EITF Issue No. 06-11 did not have a material effect on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 140-3.  In February 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position No. FAS 140-3, “Accounting for Transfers of Financial Assets and Repurchase Financing Transactions.” FSP No. FAS 140-3 requires an initial transfer of a financial asset and a repurchase financing that was entered into contemporaneously or in contemplation of the initial transfer to be evaluated as a linked transaction under SFAS No. 140 unless certain criteria are met, including that the transferred asset must be readily obtainable in the marketplace. The firm adopted FSP No. FAS 140-3 for new transactions entered into after November 2008. The adoption of FSP No. FAS 140-3 did not have a material effect on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
SFAS No. 161.  In March 2008, the FASB issued SFAS No. 161, “Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities — an amendment of FASB Statement No. 133.” SFAS No. 161 requires enhanced disclosures about an entity’s derivative and hedging activities, and was effective for the firm beginning in the one-month transition period ended December 2008. Since SFAS No. 161 requires only additional disclosures concerning derivatives and hedging activities, adoption of SFAS No. 161 did not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. EITF 03-6-1.  In June 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. EITF 03-6-1, “Determining Whether Instruments Granted in Share-Based Payment Transactions Are Participating Securities.” The FSP addresses whether instruments granted in share-based payment transactions are participating securities prior to vesting and therefore need to be included in the earnings allocation in calculating earnings per share under the two-class method described in SFAS No. 128, “Earnings per Share.” The FSP requires companies to treat unvested share-based payment awards that have non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share. The firm adopted the FSP in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. The impact for the three and six months ended June 2009 to basic earnings per common share was a reduction of $0.02 per common share. There was no impact on diluted earnings per common share. Prior periods have not been restated due to immateriality.
 
SFAS No. 141(R).  In December 2007, the FASB issued a revision to SFAS No. 141, “Business Combinations.” SFAS No. 141(R) requires changes to the accounting for transaction costs, certain contingent assets and liabilities, and other balances in a business combination. In addition, in partial acquisitions, when control is obtained, the acquiring company must measure and record all of the target’s assets and liabilities, including goodwill, at fair value as if the entire target company had been acquired. The provisions of SFAS No. 141(R) applied to the firm’s business combinations beginning in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. Adoption of SFAS No. 141(R) did not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows, but may have an effect on accounting for future business combinations.


19


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
SFAS No. 160.  In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 160, “Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements — an amendment of ARB No. 51.” SFAS No. 160 requires that ownership interests in consolidated subsidiaries held by parties other than the parent (i.e., noncontrolling interests) be accounted for and presented as equity, rather than as a liability or mezzanine equity. SFAS No. 160 was effective for the firm beginning in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. Adoption of SFAS No. 160 did not have a material effect on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8.  In December 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8, “Disclosures by Public Entities (Enterprises) about Transfers of Financial Assets and Interests in Variable Interest Entities.” FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8 requires enhanced disclosures about transfers of financial assets and interests in VIEs, and was effective for the firm beginning in the one-month transition period ended December 2008. Since the FSP requires only additional disclosures concerning transfers of financial assets and interests in VIEs, adoption of the FSP did not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
EITF Issue No. 07-5.  In June 2008, the EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 07-5, “Determining Whether an Instrument (or Embedded Feature) Is Indexed to an Entity’s Own Stock.” EITF Issue No. 07-5 provides guidance about whether an instrument (such as the firm’s outstanding common stock warrants) should be classified as equity and not subsequently recorded at fair value. The firm adopted EITF Issue No. 07-5 in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. Adoption of EITF Issue No. 07-5 did not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 157-4.  In April 2009, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 157-4, “Determining Fair Value When the Volume and Level of Activity for the Asset or Liability Have Significantly Decreased and Identifying Transactions That Are Not Orderly.” The FSP provides guidance for estimating fair value when the volume and level of activity for an asset or liability have decreased significantly. Specifically, the FSP lists factors which should be evaluated to determine whether a transaction is orderly, clarifies that adjustments to transactions or quoted prices may be necessary when the volume and level of activity for an asset or liability have decreased significantly, and provides guidance for determining the concurrent weighting of the transaction price relative to fair value indications from other valuation techniques when estimating fair value. The firm adopted FSP No. FAS 157-4 in the second quarter of 2009. Since the firm’s fair value methodologies were consistent with FSP No. FAS 157-4, adoption of the FSP did not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 115-2 and FAS 124-2.  In April 2009, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 115-2 and FAS 124-2, “Recognition and Presentation of Other-Than-Temporary Impairments.” Under the FSP, only the portion of an other-than-temporary impairment on a debt security related to credit loss is recognized in current period earnings, with the remainder recognized in other comprehensive income, if the holder does not intend to sell the security and it is more likely than not that the holder will not be required to sell the security prior to recovery. Previously, the entire other-than-temporary impairment was recognized in current period earnings. The firm adopted FSP No. FAS 115-2 and FAS 124-2 in the second quarter of 2009. Adoption of the FSP did not have a material effect on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.


20


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 107-1 and APB 28-1.  In April 2009, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 107-1 and APB 28-1, “Interim Disclosures about Fair Value of Financial Instruments.” The FSP requires that the fair value disclosures prescribed by FASB Statement No. 107, “Disclosures about Fair Value of Financial Instruments” be included in financial statements prepared for interim periods. The firm adopted FSP No. FAS 107-1 and APB 28-1 in the second quarter of 2009. The adoption of the FSP did not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
SFAS No. 165.  In May 2009, the FASB issued SFAS No. 165, “Subsequent Events,” which codifies the guidance regarding the disclosure of events occurring subsequent to the balance sheet date. SFAS No. 165 does not change the definition of a subsequent event (i.e., an event or transaction that occurs after the balance sheet date but before the financial statements are issued) but requires disclosure of the date through which subsequent events were evaluated when determining whether adjustment to or disclosure in the financial statements is required. SFAS No. 165 was effective for the firm for the second quarter of 2009. For the second quarter of 2009, the firm evaluated subsequent events through August 4, 2009. Since SFAS No. 165 requires only additional disclosures concerning subsequent events, adoption of the standard did not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
SFAS No. 166 and 167.  In June 2009, the FASB issued SFAS No. 166, “Accounting for Transfers of Financial Assets — an amendment of FASB Statement No. 140” and SFAS No. 167, “Amendments to FASB Interpretation No. 46(R),” which change the accounting for securitizations and VIEs. SFAS No. 166 will eliminate the concept of a QSPE, change the requirements for derecognizing financial assets, and require additional disclosures about transfers of financial assets, including securitization transactions and continuing involvement with transferred financial assets. SFAS No. 167 will change the determination of when a VIE should be consolidated. Under SFAS No. 167, the determination of whether to consolidate a VIE is based on the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance together with either the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could be significant to the VIE, as well as the VIE’s purpose and design. Both Statements are effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2009. The firm is currently evaluating the impact of adopting SFAS No. 166 and 167 on its financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.


21


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 3.   Financial Instruments
 
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s trading assets, at fair value, including those pledged as collateral, and trading liabilities, at fair value. At any point in time, the firm may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage a long or short risk position.
 
                                 
    As of
    June 2009   November 2008
   
Assets
 
Liabilities
 
Assets
 
Liabilities
    (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of
deposit, time deposits and other
money market instruments
  $ 16,965  (1)   $     $ 8,662  (1)   $  
Government and U.S. federal agency obligations
    136,618       48,903       69,653       37,000  
Mortgage and other asset-backed
loans and securities
    13,730       134       22,393       340  
Bank loans and bridge loans
    18,349       2,419  (4)     21,839       3,108  (4)
Corporate debt securities and
other debt obligations
    27,926       6,056       27,879       5,711  
Equities and convertible debentures
    50,955       21,634       57,049       12,116  
Physical commodities
    682             513       2  
Derivative contracts
    90,026  (2)     68,151  (5)     130,337  (2)     117,695  (5)
                                 
Total
  $ 355,251  (3)   $ 147,297     $ 338,325  (3)   $ 175,972  
                                 
 
 
(1) Includes $4.56 billion and $4.40 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, of money market instruments held by William Street Funding Corporation (Funding Corp.) to support the William Street credit extension program. See Note 8 for further information regarding the William Street program.
 
(2) Net of cash received pursuant to credit support agreements of $133.34 billion and $137.16 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(3) Includes $3.76 billion and $1.68 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, of securities held within the firm’s insurance subsidiaries which are accounted for as available-for-sale under SFAS No. 115.
 
(4) Consists of the fair value of unfunded commitments to extend credit. The fair value of partially funded commitments is included in trading assets.
 
(5) Net of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements of $16.31 billion and $34.01 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.


22


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Fair Value Hierarchy
 
The firm’s financial assets at fair value classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are summarized below:
 
                         
    As of
    June
  March
  November
    2009   2009   2008
    ($ in millions)
Total level 3 assets
  $ 54,444     $ 59,062     $ 66,190  
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure (1)
    50,383       54,660       59,574  
                         
Total assets
    889,544       925,290       884,547  
Total financial assets at fair value
    614,559       628,639       595,234  
                         
Total level 3 assets as a percentage of Total assets
    6.1 %     6.4 %     7.5 %
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure as a percentage of Total assets
    5.7       5.9       6.7  
                         
Total level 3 assets as a percentage of Total financial assets at fair value
    8.9       9.4       11.1  
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure as a percentage of Total financial assets at fair value
    8.2       8.7       10.0  
 
 
(1) Excludes assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
The following tables set forth by level within the fair value hierarchy “Trading assets, at fair value,” “Trading liabilities, at fair value,” and other financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value under the fair value option as of June 2009 and November 2008. See Note 2 for further information on the fair value hierarchy. As required by SFAS No. 157, assets and liabilities are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.


23


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                         
    Financial Assets at Fair Value as of June 2009
                Netting and
   
   
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Collateral
 
Total
    (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
  $ 8,419     $ 8,546     $     $     $ 16,965  
U.S. government and federal agency obligations
    34,720       57,352                   92,072  
Non-U.S. government obligations
    41,585       2,961                   44,546  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities:
                                       
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
          1,170       6,839             8,009  
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate (1)
          2,085       1,862             3,947  
Loan portfolios (2)
                1,774             1,774  
Bank loans and bridge loans
          8,680       9,669             18,349  
Corporate debt securities (3)
    282       17,932       2,372             20,586  
State and municipal obligations
    31       1,626       1,430             3,087  
Other debt obligations
          1,450       2,803             4,253  
Equities and convertible debentures
    20,197       18,079       12,679  (8)           50,955  
Physical commodities
          682                   682  
                                         
Cash instruments
    105,234       120,563       39,428             265,225  
Derivative contracts
    333       212,185  (6)     15,016  (6)     (137,508 (9)     90,026  
                                         
Trading assets, at fair value
    105,567       332,748       54,444       (137,508 )     355,251  
Securities segregated for regulatory
and other purposes
    14,846  (5)     17,192  (7)                 32,038  
Securities purchased under agreements to resell
          138,339                   138,339  
Securities borrowed
          87,018                   87,018  
Receivables from customers and counterparties
          1,913                   1,913  
                                         
Total financial assets at fair value
  $ 120,413     $ 577,210     $ 54,444     $ (137,508 )   $ 614,559  
                                         
Level 3 assets for which the firm does not bear economic exposure (4)
                    (4,061 )                
                                         
Level 3 assets for which the firm
bears economic exposure
                  $ 50,383                  
                                         
 
(1)  Includes $5 million and $230 million of CDOs and collateralized loan obligations (CLOs) backed by real estate within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy.
 
(2)  Consists of acquired portfolios of distressed loans, primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral.
 
(3)  Includes $222 million and $518 million of CDOs and CLOs backed by corporate obligations within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy.
 
(4)  Consists of level 3 assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
(5)  Consists of U.S. Treasury securities and money market instruments as well as insurance separate account assets measured at fair value under American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) Statement of Position (SOP) 03-1, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for Certain Nontraditional Long-Duration Contracts and for Separate Accounts.”
 
(6)  Includes $46.27 billion and $9.01 billion of credit derivative assets within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy. These amounts exclude the effects of netting under enforceable netting agreements across other derivative product types.
 
(7)  Principally consists of securities borrowed and resale agreements. The underlying securities have been segregated to satisfy certain regulatory requirements.
 
(8)  Consists of private equity and real estate fund investments.
 
(9)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.
 


24


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                         
    Financial Liabilities at Fair Value as of June 2009
                Netting and
   
   
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Collateral
 
Total
    (in millions)
U.S. government and federal agency obligations
  $ 22,928     $ 276     $     $     $ 23,204  
Non-U.S. government obligations
    25,335       364                   25,699  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities:
                                       
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
          16       4             20  
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
          114                   114  
Bank loans and bridge loans
          1,676       743             2,419  
Corporate debt securities (1)
    39       5,720       260             6,019  
State and municipal obligations
          30                   30  
Other debt obligations
                7             7  
Equities and convertible debentures
    19,921       1,707       6             21,634  
                                         
Cash instruments
    68,223       9,903       1,020             79,146  
Derivative contracts
    202       76,491  (2)     11,940  (2)     (20,482 (4)     68,151  
                                         
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    68,425       86,394       12,960       (20,482 )     147,297  
Deposits
          5,045                   5,045  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
          132,982                   132,982  
Securities loaned
          12,194                   12,194  
Other secured financings
    287       9,126       8,067             17,480  
Unsecured short-term borrowings
          12,691       2,229             14,920  
Unsecured long-term borrowings
          16,470       3,427             19,897  
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
          518       1,644             2,162  
                                         
Total financial liabilities at fair value
  $ 68,712     $ 275,420     $ 28,327  (3)   $ (20,482 )   $ 351,977  
                                         
 
 
(1)  Includes $12 million and $149 million of CDOs and CLOs backed by corporate obligations within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy.
 
(2)  Includes $9.71 billion and $6.52 billion of credit derivative liabilities within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy. These amounts exclude the effects of netting under enforceable netting agreements across other derivative product types.
 
(3)  Level 3 liabilities were 8.0% of Total financial liabilities at fair value.
 
(4)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.

25


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                         
    Financial Assets at Fair Value as of November 2008
                Netting and
   
   
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Collateral
 
Total
    (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
  $ 5,205     $ 3,457     $     $     $ 8,662  
Government and U.S. federal agency obligations
    35,069       34,584                   69,653  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
          6,886       15,507             22,393  
Bank loans and bridge loans
          9,882       11,957             21,839  
Corporate debt securities and
other debt obligations
    14       20,269       7,596             27,879  
Equities and convertible debentures
    25,068       15,975       16,006  (5)           57,049  
Physical commodities
          513                   513  
                                         
Cash instruments
    65,356       91,566       51,066             207,988  
Derivative contracts
    24       256,412  (3)     15,124  (3)     (141,223 (6)     130,337  
                                         
Trading assets, at fair value
    65,380       347,978       66,190       (141,223 )     338,325  
Securities segregated for regulatory
and other purposes
    20,030  (2)     58,800  (4)                 78,830  
Securities purchased under agreements to resell
          116,671                   116,671  
Securities borrowed
          59,810                   59,810  
Receivables from customers and counterparties
          1,598                   1,598  
                                         
Total financial assets at fair value
  $ 85,410     $ 584,857     $ 66,190     $ (141,223 )   $ 595,234  
                                         
Level 3 assets for which the firm does
not bear economic exposure (1)
                    (6,616 )                
                                         
Level 3 assets for which the firm
bears economic exposure
                  $ 59,574                  
                                         
 
 
(1)  Consists of level 3 assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
(2)  Consists of U.S. Treasury securities and money market instruments as well as insurance separate account assets measured at fair value under AICPA SOP 03-1.
 
(3)  Includes $66.00 billion and $8.32 billion of credit derivative assets within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy. These amounts exclude the effects of netting under enforceable netting agreements across other derivative product types.
 
(4)  Principally consists of securities borrowed and resale agreements. The underlying securities have been segregated to satisfy certain regulatory requirements.
 
(5)  Consists of private equity and real estate fund investments.
 
(6)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.
 


26


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                         
    Financial Liabilities at Fair Value as of November 2008
                Netting and
   
   
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Collateral
 
Total
    (in millions)
Government and U.S. federal agency obligations
  $ 36,385     $ 615     $     $     $ 37,000  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
          320       20             340  
Bank loans and bridge loans
          2,278       830             3,108  
Corporate debt securities and
other debt obligations
    11       5,185       515             5,711  
Equities and convertible debentures
    11,928       174       14             12,116  
Physical commodities
    2                         2  
                                         
Cash instruments
    48,326       8,572       1,379             58,277  
Derivative contracts
    21       145,777  (1)     9,968  (1)     (38,071 (3)     117,695  
                                         
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    48,347       154,349       11,347       (38,071 )     175,972  
Deposits
          4,224                   4,224  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
          62,883                   62,883  
Securities loaned
          7,872                   7,872  
Other secured financings
          16,429       3,820             20,249  
Unsecured short-term borrowings
          17,916       5,159             23,075  
Unsecured long-term borrowings
          15,886       1,560             17,446  
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
          978                   978  
                                         
Total financial liabilities at fair value
  $ 48,347     $ 280,537     $ 21,886  (2)   $ (38,071 )   $ 312,699  
                                         
 
 
(1)  Includes $31.20 billion and $4.74 billion of credit derivative liabilities within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy. These amounts exclude the effects of netting under enforceable netting agreements across other derivative product types.
 
(2)  Level 3 liabilities were 7.0% of Total financial liabilities at fair value.
 
(3)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.

27


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Level 3 Unrealized Gains/(Losses)
 
The table below sets forth a summary of unrealized gains/(losses) on the firm’s level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value still held at the reporting date for the three and six months ended June 2009 and May 2008:
 
                                 
    Level 3 Unrealized Gains/(Losses)
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
Cash instruments — assets
  $ (1,932 )   $ (944 )   $ (5,597 )   $ (3,194 )
Cash instruments — liabilities
    289             280       (264 )
                                 
Net unrealized losses on level 3 cash instruments
    (1,643 )     (944 )     (5,317 )     (3,458 )
Derivative contracts — net
    (1,403 )     (447 )     (171 )     1,900  
Other secured financings
    (442 )           (426 )      
Unsecured short-term borrowings
    (189 )     (18 )     (50 )     40  
Unsecured long-term borrowings
    (133 )     (71 )     (98 )     32  
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
    18             81        
                                 
Total level 3 unrealized losses
  $ (3,792 )   $ (1,480 )   $ (5,981 )   $ (1,486 )
                                 
 
Cash Instruments
 
The net unrealized loss on level 3 cash instruments of $1.64 billion for the three months ended June 2009 primarily consisted of unrealized losses on real estate fund investments, and loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, reflecting continued weakness in the commercial real estate market. The net unrealized loss on level 3 cash instruments of $944 million for the three months ended May 2008 primarily consisted of unrealized losses on certain bank loans and bridge loans, and corporate debt securities and other debt obligations, reflecting weakness in the credit markets. The net unrealized loss on level 3 cash instruments of $5.32 billion for the six months ended June 2009 primarily consisted of unrealized losses on private equity and real estate fund investments, and loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, reflecting weakness in the global equity markets in the first quarter of 2009, as well as weakness in the commercial real estate market. The net unrealized loss on level 3 cash instruments of $3.46 billion for the six months ended May 2008 primarily consisted of unrealized losses on loans and securities backed by commercial and residential real estate, certain bank loans and bridge loans, and corporate debt securities and other debt obligations, reflecting weakness in the broader credit markets.
 
Level 3 cash instruments are frequently economically hedged with instruments classified within level 1 and level 2, and accordingly, gains or losses that have been reported in level 3 can be partially offset by gains or losses attributable to instruments classified within level 1 or level 2 or by gains or losses on derivative contracts classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.


28


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Derivative Contracts
 
The net unrealized loss on level 3 derivative contracts of $1.40 billion for the three months ended June 2009 was primarily driven by tighter credit spreads (which are level 2 observable inputs) on the underlying instruments. The net unrealized loss of $171 million for the six months ended June 2009 was primarily attributable to tighter credit spreads on the underlying instruments partially offset by increases in commodities prices (which are level 2 observable inputs). The net unrealized loss on level 3 derivative contracts of $447 million for the three months ended May 2008 and net unrealized gain of $1.90 billion for the six months ended May 2008 were primarily attributable to observable changes in underlying credit spreads (which are level 2 inputs). Level 3 gains and losses on derivative contracts should be considered in the context of the following:
 
  •  A derivative contract with level 1 and/or level 2 inputs is classified as a level 3 financial instrument in its entirety if it has at least one significant level 3 input.
 
  •  If there is one significant level 3 input, the entire gain or loss from adjusting only observable inputs (i.e., level 1 and level 2) is still classified as level 3.
 
  •  Gains or losses that have been reported in level 3 resulting from changes in level 1 or level 2 inputs are frequently offset by gains or losses attributable to instruments classified within level 1 or level 2 or by cash instruments reported within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
The tables below set forth a summary of changes in the fair value of the firm’s level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities for the three and six months ended June 2009 and May 2008. The tables reflect gains and losses, including gains and losses for the entire period on financial assets and financial liabilities that were transferred to level 3 during the period, for all financial assets and financial liabilities categorized as level 3 as of June 2009 and May 2008, respectively. The tables do not include gains or losses that were reported in level 3 in prior periods for instruments that were sold or transferred out of level 3 prior to the end of the period presented.
 
                                                 
    Level 3 Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value
            Net unrealized
           
            gains/(losses)
  Net
       
            relating to
  purchases,
       
    Balance,
      instruments still
  issuances
  Net transfers
  Balance,
    beginning of
  Net realized
  held at the
  and
  in and/or out
  end of
   
period
 
gains/(losses)
 
reporting date
 
settlements
 
of level 3
 
period
    (in millions)
Three Months Ended June 2009
                                               
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities:
                                               
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
  $ 7,705     $ (207 )   $ (637 )   $ (92 )   $ 70     $ 6,839  
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
    2,088       101       (14 )     (301 )     (12 )     1,862  
Loan portfolios
    1,851       41       (29 )     (89 )           1,774  
Bank loans and bridge loans
    9,866       169       (74 )     (679 )     387       9,669  
Corporate debt securities
    2,648       23       (70 )     (161 )     (68 )     2,372  
State and municipal obligations
    1,157       3       (5 )     (33 )     308       1,430  
Other debt obligations
    3,749       119       (166 )     (626 )     (273 )     2,803  
Equities and convertible debentures
    13,620       11       (937 )     118       (133 )     12,679  
                                                 
Total cash instruments — assets
    42,684       260   (1)     (1,932 (1)     (1,863 )     279       39,428  
                                                 
Cash instruments — liabilities
    (1,304 )     (9 (2)     289   (2)     (31 )     35       (1,020 )
Derivative contracts — net
    4,116       474   (2)     (1,403 (2)(3)     (141 )     30   (4)     3,076  
Other secured financings
    (7,277 )     (15 (2)     (442 (2)     90       (423 (5)     (8,067 )
Unsecured short-term borrowings
    (3,143 )     1   (2)     (189 (2)     (219 )     1,321   (6)     (2,229 )
Unsecured long-term borrowings
    (1,916 )     (25 (2)     (133 (2)     54       (1,407 (6)     (3,427 )
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
    (1,510 )     (11 (2)     18   (2)     (141 )           (1,644 )


29


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                                 
    Level 3 Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value
            Net unrealized
           
            gains/(losses)
  Net
       
            relating to
  purchases,
       
    Balance,
      instruments still
  issuances
  Net transfers
  Balance,
    beginning of
  Net realized
  held at the
  and
  in and/or out
  end of
   
period
 
gains/(losses)
 
reporting date
 
settlements
 
of level 3
 
period
    (in millions)
Six Months Ended June 2009
                                               
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities:
                                               
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
  $ 9,170     $ (148 )   $ (1,546 )   $ (530 )   $ (107 )   $ 6,839  
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
    1,927       183       (123 )     (505 )     380       1,862  
Loan portfolios
    4,266       90       (269 )     (766 )     (1,547 (7)     1,774  
Bank loans and bridge loans
    11,169       344       (682 )     (1,227 )     65       9,669  
Corporate debt securities
    2,734       163       (349 )     13       (189 )     2,372  
State and municipal obligations
    1,356       7       (9 )     (219 )     295       1,430  
Other debt obligations
    3,903       68       (211 )     (920 )     (37 )     2,803  
Equities and convertible debentures
    15,127       7       (2,408 )     (56 )     9       12,679  
                                                 
Total cash instruments — assets
    49,652       714   (1)     (5,597 (1)     (4,210 )     (1,131 )     39,428  
                                                 
Cash instruments — liabilities
    (1,727 )     (2 (2)     280   (2)     274       155       (1,020 )
Derivative contracts — net
    3,315       577   (2)     (171 (2)(3)     (1,446 )     801   (8)     3,076  
Other secured financings
    (4,039 )     (21 (2)     (426 (2)     (1,053 )     (2,528 (9)     (8,067 )
Unsecured short-term borrowings
    (4,712 )     8   (2)     (50 (2)     (1,039 )     3,564   (9)     (2,229 )
Unsecured long-term borrowings
    (1,689 )     15   (2)     (98 (2)     225       (1,880 (9)     (3,427 )
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
          (21 (2)     81   (2)     (751 )     (953 (10)     (1,644 )
 
 
  (1)  The aggregate amounts include approximately $(2.18) billion and $510 million reported in “Trading and principal investments” and “Interest income,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statement of earnings for the three months ended June 2009. The aggregate amounts include approximately $(5.96) billion and $1.08 billion reported in “Trading and principal investments” and “Interest income,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statement of earnings for the six months ended June 2009.
 
  (2)  Substantially all is reported in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
  (3)  Primarily resulted from changes in level 2 inputs.
 
  (4)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of credit derivative assets, reflecting reduced transparency of the correlation inputs used to value these financial instruments, offset by transfers to level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of equity derivative assets, reflecting improved transparency of the equity index volatility inputs used to value these financial instruments.
 
  (5)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy due to reduced transparency of prices for municipal obligations that collateralize certain secured financings.
 
  (6)  Principally reflects transfers from level 3 unsecured short-term borrowings to level 3 unsecured long-term borrowings related to changes in the terms of certain notes.
 
  (7)  Principally reflects the deconsolidation of certain loan portfolios for which the firm did not bear economic exposure.
 
  (8)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of credit derivative assets, reflecting reduced transparency of certain credit spread inputs used to value these financial instruments, partially offset by transfers to level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of equity derivative assets, reflecting improved transparency of the equity index volatility inputs used to value these financial instruments.
 
  (9)  Principally reflects transfers from level 3 unsecured short-term borrowings to level 3 other secured financings and level 3 unsecured long-term borrowings related to changes in the terms of certain notes.
 
(10)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of certain insurance contracts, reflecting reduced transparency of mortality curve inputs used to value these instruments.
 

30


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                                 
    Level 3 Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value
            Net unrealized
           
            gains/(losses)
  Net
       
            relating to
  purchases,
       
    Balance,
      instruments still
  issuances
  Net transfers
  Balance,
    beginning of
  Net realized
  held at the
  and
  in and/or out
  end of
   
period
 
gains/(losses)
 
reporting date
 
settlements
 
of level 3
 
period
    (in millions)
Three Months Ended May 2008
                                               
Cash instruments — assets
  $ 71,373     $ 624   (1)   $ (944 (1)   $ (2,330 (4)   $ (9,052 (4)(5)   $ 59,671  
Cash instruments — liabilities
    (977 )     13   (2)           301       82       (581 )
Derivative contracts — net
    9,394       (8 (2)     (447 (2)(3)     68       (2,499 (6)     6,508  
Other secured financings
          (6 (2)           18       (892 (7)     (880 )
Unsecured short-term borrowings
    (3,839 )     (134 (2)     (18 (2)     357       (203 )     (3,837 )
Unsecured long-term borrowings
    (1,247 )     (4 (2)     (71 (2)     (603 )     (77 )     (2,002 )
                                                 
Six Months Ended May 2008
                                               
Cash instruments — assets
  $ 53,451     $ 1,370   (1)   $ (3,194 (1)   $ 5,422     $ 2,622   (8)   $ 59,671  
Cash instruments — liabilities
    (554 )     10   (2)     (264 (2)     251       (24 )     (581 )
Derivative contracts — net
    2,056       104   (2)     1,900   (2)(3)     71       2,377   (9)     6,508  
Other secured financings
          (6 (2)           (874 )           (880 )
Unsecured short-term borrowings
    (4,271 )     (184 (2)     40   (2)     699       (121 )     (3,837 )
Unsecured long-term borrowings
    (767 )     5   (2)     32   (2)     (1,072 )     (200 )     (2,002 )
 
 
(1)  The aggregate amounts include approximately $(1.02) billion and $696 million reported in “Trading and principal investments” and “Interest income,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statement of earnings for the three months ended May 2008. The aggregate amounts include approximately $(3.09) billion and $1.27 billion reported in “Trading and principal investments” and “Interest income,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statement of earnings for the six months ended May 2008.
 
(2)  Substantially all is reported in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
(3)  Principally resulted from changes in level 2 inputs.
 
(4)  The aggregate amount includes a decrease of $8.80 billion due to full and partial dispositions.
 
(5)  Includes transfers of loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, and bank loans and bridge loans to level 2 within the fair value hierarchy, reflecting improved price transparency for these financial instruments, largely as a result of partial dispositions.
 
(6)  Principally reflects transfers to level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of mortgage-related derivative assets due to improved transparency of the correlation inputs used to value these financial instruments.
 
(7)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy due to reduced transparency of prices for debt obligations that collateralize certain secured financings.
 
(8)  Principally reflects transfers of corporate debt securities and other debt obligations, and loans and securities backed by commercial real estate from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy, reflecting reduced price transparency for these financial instruments.
 
(9)  Principally reflects transfers to level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of derivative liabilities due to improved transparency of the correlation inputs used to value these financial instruments.

31


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Impact of Credit Spreads
 
On an ongoing basis, the firm realizes gains or losses relating to changes in credit risk on derivative contracts through changes in credit mitigants or the sale or unwind of the contracts. The net gain/(loss) attributable to the impact of changes in credit exposure and credit spreads on derivative contracts (including derivative assets and liabilities and related hedges) was $38 million and $(145) million for the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, and $86 million and $(129) million for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively.
 
The following table sets forth the net gains/(losses) attributable to the impact of changes in the firm’s own credit spreads on unsecured borrowings for which the fair value option was elected. The firm calculates the fair value of unsecured borrowings by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates the firm’s observable credit spreads.
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
Net gains/(losses) including hedges
  $ (348 )   $ (178 )   $ (545 )   $ 155  
Net gains/(losses) excluding hedges
    (353 )     (375 )     (545 )     143  
 
The impact of changes in instrument-specific credit spreads on loans and loan commitments for which the fair value option was elected was a gain of $917 million and a loss of $297 million for the three and six months ended June 2009, respectively, and not material for the three and six months ended May 2008. The firm attributes changes in the fair value of floating rate loans and loan commitments to changes in instrument-specific credit spreads. For fixed rate loans and loan commitments, the firm allocates changes in fair value between interest rate-related changes and credit spread-related changes based on changes in interest rates. See below for additional details regarding the fair value option.


32


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The Fair Value Option
 
Gains/(Losses)
 
The following table sets forth the gains/(losses) included in earnings for the three and six months ended June 2009 and May 2008 as a result of the firm electing to apply the fair value option to certain financial assets and financial liabilities, as described in Note 2. The table excludes gains and losses related to trading assets and trading liabilities, as well as gains and losses that would have been recognized under other generally accepted accounting principles if the firm had not elected the fair value option or that are economically hedged with instruments accounted for at fair value under other generally accepted accounting principles.
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
Unsecured long-term borrowings (1)
  $ (307 )   $ (371 )   $ (442 )   $ 135  
Other secured financings (2)
    (442 )     124       (417 )     123  
Unsecured short-term borrowings (3)
    (27 )     25       (94 )     (25 )
Receivables from customers and counterparties (4)
    84       1       82       1  
Other liabilities and accrued expenses (5)
    (162 )           (80 )      
Other (6)
    34       (28 )     8       (22 )
                                 
Total (7)
  $ (820 )   $ (249 )   $ (943 )   $ 212  
                                 
 
 
(1) Excludes losses of $2.96 billion and $1.54 billion for the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, and $1.72 billion and $2.26 billion for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, related to the embedded derivative component of hybrid financial instruments. Such losses would have been recognized pursuant to SFAS No. 133 if the firm had not elected to account for the entire hybrid instrument at fair value under the fair value option.
 
(2) Excludes gains/(losses) of $(12) million and $10 million for the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, and $7 million and $1.04 billion for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, related to financings recorded as a result of securitization-related transactions that were accounted for as secured financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140. Changes in the fair value of these secured financings are offset by changes in the fair value of the related financial instruments included within the firm’s “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
(3) Excludes gains/(losses) of $(1.18) billion and $(59) million for the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, $(1.48) billion and $253 million for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, related to the embedded derivative component of hybrid financial instruments. Such gains and losses would have been recognized pursuant to SFAS No. 133 if the firm had not elected to account for the entire hybrid instrument at fair value under the fair value option.
 
(4) Primarily consists of gains on certain reinsurance contracts.
 
(5) Primarily consists of losses on certain insurance and reinsurance contracts.
 
(6) Primarily consists of gains/(losses) on resale and repurchase agreements, and securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments.
 
(7) Reported within “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. The amounts exclude contractual interest, which is included in “Interest income” and “Interest expense” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings, for all instruments other than hybrid financial instruments.


33


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
All trading assets and trading liabilities are accounted for at fair value either under the fair value option or as required by other accounting pronouncements. Excluding equities commissions of $1.02 billion and $1.23 billion for the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, and $2.00 billion and $2.47 billion for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, and the gains and losses on the instruments accounted for under the fair value option described above, the firm’s “Trading and principal investments” revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings primarily represent gains and losses on “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Loans and Loan Commitments
 
As of June 2009, the aggregate contractual principal amount of loans and long-term receivables for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $45.31 billion, including a difference of $37.53 billion related to loans with an aggregate fair value of $4.60 billion that were on nonaccrual status (including loans more than 90 days past due). As of November 2008, the aggregate contractual principal amount of loans and long-term receivables for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $50.21 billion, including a difference of $37.46 billion related to loans with an aggregate fair value of $3.77 billion that were on nonaccrual status (including loans more than 90 days past due). The aggregate contractual principal exceeds the related fair value primarily because the firm regularly purchases loans, such as distressed loans, at values significantly below contractual principal amounts.
 
As of June 2009 and November 2008, the fair value of unfunded lending commitments for which the fair value option was elected was a liability of $1.78 billion and $3.52 billion, respectively, and the related total contractual amount of these lending commitments was $38.58 billion and $39.49 billion, respectively.
 
Long-term Debt Instruments
 
The aggregate contractual principal amount of long-term debt instruments (principal and non-principal protected) for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $1.95 billion and $2.42 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
Derivative Activities
 
Derivative contracts are instruments, such as futures, forwards, swaps or option contracts, that derive their value from underlying assets, indices, reference rates or a combination of these factors. Derivative instruments may be privately negotiated contracts, which are often referred to as OTC derivatives, or they may be listed and traded on an exchange. Derivatives may involve future commitments to purchase or sell financial instruments or commodities, or to exchange currency or interest payment streams. The amounts exchanged are based on the specific terms of the contract with reference to specified rates, securities, commodities, currencies or indices.
 
Certain cash instruments, such as mortgage-backed securities, interest-only and principal-only obligations, and indexed debt instruments, are not considered derivatives even though their values or contractually required cash flows are derived from the price of some other security or index. However, certain commodity-related contracts are included in the firm’s derivatives disclosure, as these contracts may be settled in cash or the assets to be delivered under the contract are readily convertible into cash.


34


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The firm enters into derivative transactions to facilitate client transactions, to take proprietary positions and as a means of risk management. Risk exposures are managed through diversification, by controlling position sizes and by entering into offsetting positions. For example, the firm may manage the risk related to a portfolio of common stock by entering into an offsetting position in a related equity-index futures contract.
 
The firm applies hedge accounting under SFAS No. 133 to certain derivative contracts. The firm uses these derivatives to manage certain interest rate and currency exposures, including the firm’s net investment in non-U.S. operations. The firm designates certain interest rate swap contracts as fair value hedges. These interest rate swap contracts hedge changes in the relevant benchmark interest rate (e.g., London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR)), effectively converting a substantial portion of the firm’s unsecured long-term borrowings, certain unsecured short-term borrowings and certificates of deposit into floating rate obligations. See Note 2 for information regarding the firm’s accounting policy for foreign currency forward contracts used to hedge its net investment in non-U.S. operations.
 
The firm applies a long-haul method to all of its hedge accounting relationships to perform an ongoing assessment of the effectiveness of these relationships in achieving offsetting changes in fair value or offsetting cash flows attributable to the risk being hedged. The firm utilizes a dollar-offset method, which compares the change in the fair value of the hedging instrument to the change in the fair value of the hedged item, excluding the effect of the passage of time, to prospectively and retrospectively assess hedge effectiveness. The firm’s prospective dollar-offset assessment utilizes scenario analyses to test hedge effectiveness via simulations of numerous parallel and slope shifts of the relevant yield curve. Parallel shifts change the interest rate of all maturities by identical amounts. Slope shifts change the curvature of the yield curve. For both the prospective assessment, in response to each of the simulated yield curve shifts, and the retrospective assessment, a hedging relationship is deemed to be effective if the fair value of the hedging instrument and the hedged item change inversely within a range of 80% to 125%.
 
For fair value hedges, gains or losses on derivative transactions are recognized in “Interest expense” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. The change in fair value of the hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged is reported as an adjustment to its carrying value and is subsequently amortized into interest expense over its remaining life. Gains or losses related to hedge ineffectiveness for these hedges are generally included in “Interest expense” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. These gains or losses were not material for the three and six months ended June 2009 and May 2008. Gains and losses on derivatives used for trading purposes are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
The fair value of the firm’s derivative contracts is reflected net of cash paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements and is reported on a net-by-counterparty basis in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition when management believes a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement. The following table sets forth the fair value and the number of contracts of the firm’s derivative contracts by major product type on a gross basis as of June 2009. Gross fair values in the table below exclude the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash received or posted pursuant to credit support agreements, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s exposure:
 


35


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
                         
    As of June 2009
    Derivative
  Derivative
  Number of
   
Assets
 
Liabilities
 
Contracts
    (in millions, except number of contracts)
Derivative contracts for trading activities
                       
                         
Interest rates
  $ 539,606  (4)   $ 486,423  (4)     275,197  
Credit
    291,660       252,615       464,120  
Currencies
    87,011       76,341       200,828  
Commodities
    63,188       60,539       201,563  
Equities
    91,474       79,143       278,774  
                         
Subtotal
  $ 1,072,939     $ 955,061       1,420,482  
                         
Derivative contracts accounted for as
hedges under SFAS No. 133
(1)
                       
                         
Interest rates
  $ 21,039  (5)   $ 6  (5)     825  
Currencies
    10  (6)     20  (6)     30  
                         
Subtotal
  $ 21,049     $ 26       855  
                         
Gross fair value of derivative contracts
  $ 1,093,988     $ 955,087       1,421,337  
                         
Counterparty netting (2)
    (870,627 )     (870,627 )        
Cash collateral netting (3)
    (133,335 )     (16,309 )        
                         
Fair value included in “Trading assets, at fair value”
  $ 90,026                  
                         
Fair value included in “Trading liabilities, at fair value”
          $ 68,151          
                         
 
 
(1) As of November 2008, the gross fair value of derivative contracts accounted for as hedges under SFAS No. 133 consisted of $20.40 billion in assets and $128 million in liabilities.
 
(2) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty pursuant to credit support agreements in accordance with FIN 39.
 
(3) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(4) Presented after giving effect to $410.20 billion of derivative assets and $390.04 billion of derivative liabilities settled with clearing organizations.
 
(5) For the three and six months ended June 2009, the loss recognized on these derivative contracts was $5.54 billion and $8.01 billion, respectively, and the related gain recognized on the hedged borrowings and bank deposits was $5.54 billion and $7.97 billion, respectively. These gains and losses are included in “Interest expense” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. For the three and six months ended June 2009, the loss recognized on these derivative contracts included losses of $350 million and $666 million, respectively, which were excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness.
 
(6) For the three and six months ended June 2009, the loss on these derivative contracts was $450 million and $297 million, respectively. Such amounts are included in “Currency translation adjustment, net of tax” in the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income. The gain/(loss) related to ineffectiveness and the gain/(loss) reclassified to earnings from accumulated other comprehensive income were not material for the three and six months ended June 2009.

36


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The firm also has embedded derivatives that have been bifurcated from related borrowings under SFAS No. 133. Such derivatives, which are classified in unsecured short-term and unsecured long-term borrowings in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, had a net asset carrying value of $363 million and $774 million as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. The net asset as of June 2009, which represented 339 contracts, included gross assets of $698 million (primarily comprised of equity, credit and interest rate derivatives) and gross liabilities of $335 million (primarily comprised of equity and interest rate derivatives). See Notes 6 and 7 for further information regarding the firm’s unsecured borrowings.
 
As of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, the firm has designated $3.31 billion and $3.36 billion of foreign currency-denominated debt, included in unsecured long-term borrowings in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, as hedges of net investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries under SFAS No. 133. For the three and six months ended June 2009, the gain/(loss) on these debt instruments was $(90) million and $179 million, respectively. Such amounts are included in “Currency translation adjustment, net of tax” in the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income. The gain/(loss) related to ineffectiveness and the gain/(loss) reclassified to earnings from accumulated other comprehensive income were not material for the three and six months ended June 2009.
 
The following table sets forth by major product type the firm’s gains/(losses) related to trading activities, including both derivative and nonderivative financial instruments, for the three and six months ended June 2009 in accordance with SFAS No. 161. These gains/(losses) are not representative of the firm’s individual business unit results because many of the firm’s trading strategies utilize financial instruments across various product types. Accordingly, gains or losses in one product type frequently offset gains or losses in other product types. For example, most of the firm’s longer-term derivative contracts are sensitive to changes in interest rates and may be hedged with interest rate swaps. Similarly, a significant portion of the firm’s cash and derivatives trading inventory has exposure to foreign currencies and may be hedged with foreign currency contracts. The gains/(losses) set forth below are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings and exclude related interest income and interest expense.
 
                 
    Three Months
  Six Months
    Ended June   Ended June
    2009   2009
    (in millions)
Interest rates
  $ 3,814     $ 4,386  
Credit
    1,014       2,336  
Currencies
    (1,398 (1)     (421 )
Equities
    2,743       4,109  
Commodities and other
    1,574       3,343  
                 
Total
  $ 7,747     $ 13,753  
                 
 
 
(1) Includes gains/(losses) on currency contracts used to hedge positions included in other product types in this table.


37


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Certain of the firm’s derivative instruments have been transacted pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties that may require the firm to post collateral or terminate the transactions based on the firm’s long-term credit ratings. As of June 2009, the aggregate fair value of such derivative contracts that were in a net liability position was $31.19 billion, and the aggregate fair value of assets posted by the firm as collateral for these derivative contracts was $14.26 billion. As of June 2009, additional collateral or termination payments pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties of approximately $763 million and $1.93 billion could have been called by counterparties in the event of a one-notch and two-notch reduction, respectively, in the firm’s long-term credit ratings.
 
The firm enters into various derivative transactions that are considered credit derivatives under FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4. The firm’s written and purchased credit derivatives include credit default swaps, credit spread options, credit index products and total return swaps. As individually negotiated contracts, credit derivatives can have numerous settlement and payment conventions. The more common types of triggers include bankruptcy of the reference credit entity, acceleration of indebtedness, failure to pay, restructuring, repudiation and dissolution of the entity. Substantially all of the firm’s purchased credit derivative transactions are with financial institutions and are subject to stringent collateral thresholds. As of June 2009, the firm’s written and purchased credit derivatives had total gross notional amounts of $2.96 trillion and $3.19 trillion, respectively, for total net purchased protection of $227.02 billion in notional value. As of November 2008, the firm’s written and purchased credit derivatives had total gross notional amounts of $3.78 trillion and $4.03 trillion, respectively, for total net purchased protection of $255.24 billion in notional value. The decrease in notional amounts from November 2008 to June 2009 primarily reflects compression efforts across the industry.


38


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The following table sets forth certain information related to the firm’s credit derivatives. Fair values in the table below exclude the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s exposure.
 
                                                         
        Maximum Payout/Notional
   
    Maximum Payout/Notional Amount
  Amount of Purchased
   
    of Written Credit Derivatives by Tenor (1)   Credit Derivatives    
                    Offsetting
  Other
   
            5 Years
      Purchased
  Purchased
  Written Credit
    0 - 12
  1 - 5
  or
      Credit
  Credit
  Derivatives at
    Months   Years   Greater   Total   Derivatives (2)   Derivatives (3)   Fair Value
    ($ in millions)
As of June 2009
                                                       
Credit spread on
underlying (basis points)
(4)
                                                       
0-250
  $ 193,565     $ 1,269,520     $ 351,796     $ 1,814,881     $ 1,713,493     $ 179,753     $ 46,316  
251-500
    52,816       362,155       203,387       618,358       562,599       90,180       44,985  
501-1,000
    24,122       174,015       43,871       242,008       228,985       89,162       24,115  
Greater than 1,000
    44,752       210,653       29,516       284,921       254,360       68,654       91,411  
                                                         
Total
  $ 315,255     $ 2,016,343     $ 628,570     $ 2,960,168     $ 2,759,437     $ 427,749     $ 206,827  (5)
                                                         
As of November 2008
                                                       
Credit spread on
underlying (basis points)
(4)
                                                       
0-250
  $ 108,555     $ 1,093,651     $ 623,944     $ 1,826,150     $ 1,632,681     $ 347,573     $ 77,836  
251-500
    51,015       551,971       186,084       789,070       784,149       26,316       94,278  
501-1,000
    34,756       404,661       148,052       587,469       538,251       67,958       75,079  
Greater than 1,000
    41,496       373,211       161,475       576,182       533,816       103,362       222,346  
                                                         
Total
  $ 235,822     $ 2,423,494     $ 1,119,555     $ 3,778,871     $ 3,488,897     $ 545,209     $ 469,539  (5)
                                                         
 
 
(1)  Tenor is based on expected duration for mortgage-related credit derivatives and on remaining contractual maturity for other credit derivatives.
 
(2)  Offsetting purchased credit derivatives represent the notional amount of purchased credit derivatives to the extent they hedge written credit derivatives with identical underlyings.
 
(3)  Comprised of purchased protection in excess of the amount of written protection on identical underlyings and purchased protection on other underlyings on which the firm has not written protection.
 
(4)  Credit spread on the underlying, together with the tenor of the contract, are indicators of payment/performance risk. For example, the firm is least likely to pay or otherwise be required to perform where the credit spread on the underlying is “0-250” basis points and the tenor is “0-12 Months.” The likelihood of payment or performance is generally greater as the credit spread on the underlying and tenor increase.
 
(5)  This liability excludes the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash collateral paid pursuant to credit support agreements. Including the effects of netting receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty pursuant to enforceable netting agreements, the firm’s net liability related to credit derivatives in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition as of June 2009 and November 2008 was $13.46 billion and $33.76 billion, respectively. This net amount excludes the netting of cash collateral paid pursuant to credit support agreements. The decrease in this net liability from November 2008 to June 2009 reflected tightening credit spreads.


39


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Collateralized Transactions
 
The firm receives financial instruments as collateral, primarily in connection with resale agreements, securities borrowed, derivative transactions and customer margin loans. Such financial instruments may include obligations of the U.S. government, federal agencies, sovereigns and corporations, as well as equities and convertibles.
 
In many cases, the firm is permitted to deliver or repledge these financial instruments in connection with entering into repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements and other secured financings, collateralizing derivative transactions and meeting firm or customer settlement requirements. As of June 2009 and November 2008, the fair value of financial instruments received as collateral by the firm that it was permitted to deliver or repledge was $596.34 billion and $578.72 billion, respectively, of which the firm delivered or repledged $435.55 billion and $445.11 billion, respectively.
 
The firm also pledges assets that it owns to counterparties who may or may not have the right to deliver or repledge them. Trading assets pledged to counterparties that have the right to deliver or repledge are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and were $31.14 billion and $26.31 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. Trading assets, pledged in connection with repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements and other secured financings to counterparties that did not have the right to sell or repledge are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and were $122.01 billion and $80.85 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. Other assets (primarily real estate and cash) owned and pledged in connection with other secured financings to counterparties that did not have the right to sell or repledge were $6.61 billion and $9.24 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
In addition to repurchase agreements and securities lending agreements, the firm obtains secured funding through the use of other arrangements. Other secured financings include arrangements that are nonrecourse, that is, only the subsidiary that executed the arrangement or a subsidiary guaranteeing the arrangement is obligated to repay the financing. Other secured financings consist of liabilities related to the firm’s William Street program; consolidated VIEs; collateralized central bank financings and other transfers of financial assets that are accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140 (primarily pledged bank loans and mortgage whole loans); and other structured financing arrangements.


40


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Other secured financings by maturity are set forth in the table below:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
Other secured financings (short-term) (1)(2)
  $ 14,239     $ 21,225  
Other secured financings (long-term):
               
2010
    3,113       2,157  
2011
    3,766       4,578  
2012
    3,195       3,040  
2013
    1,558       1,377  
2014
    1,319       1,512  
2015-thereafter
    3,107       4,794  
                 
Total other secured financings (long-term) (3)(4)
    16,058       17,458  
                 
Total other secured financings (5)(6)
  $ 30,297     $ 38,683  
                 
 
 
(1) As of June 2009 and November 2008, consists of U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $5.06 billion and $12.53 billion, respectively, with a weighted average interest rate of 1.35% and 2.98%, respectively, and non-U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $9.18 billion and $8.70 billion, respectively, with a weighted average interest rate of 0.62% and 0.95%, respectively, after giving effect to hedging activities. The weighted average interest rates as of June 2009 and November 2008 excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159.
 
(2) Includes other secured financings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and other secured financings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder.
 
(3) As of June 2009 and November 2008, consists of U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $9.41 billion and $9.55 billion, respectively, with a weighted average interest rate of 2.80% and 4.62%, respectively, and non-U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $6.65 billion and $7.91 billion, respectively, with a weighted average interest rate of 2.55% and 4.39%, respectively, after giving effect to hedging activities. The weighted average interest rates as of June 2009 and November 2008 excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159.
 
(4) Secured long-term financings that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Secured long-term financings that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.
 
(5) As of June 2009 and November 2008, $25.83 billion and $31.54 billion, respectively, of these financings were collateralized by trading assets and $4.47 billion and $7.14 billion, respectively, by other assets (primarily real estate and cash). Other secured financings include $11.50 billion and $13.74 billion of nonrecourse obligations as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(6) As of June 2009, other secured financings includes $16.13 billion, respectively, related to transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140. Such financings were collateralized by financial assets included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition of $16.54 billion as of June 2009, respectively.


41


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 4.   Securitization Activities and Variable Interest Entities
 
Securitization Activities
 
The firm securitizes commercial and residential mortgages, government and corporate bonds and other types of financial assets. The firm acts as underwriter of the beneficial interests that are sold to investors. The firm derecognizes financial assets transferred in securitizations, provided it has relinquished control over such assets. Transferred assets are accounted for at fair value prior to securitization. Net revenues related to these underwriting activities are recognized in connection with the sales of the underlying beneficial interests to investors.
 
The firm may have continuing involvement with transferred assets, including: retaining interests in securitized financial assets, primarily in the form of senior or subordinated securities; retaining servicing rights; and purchasing senior or subordinated securities in connection with secondary market-making activities. Retained interests and other interests related to the firm’s continuing involvement are accounted for at fair value and are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. See Note 2 for additional information regarding fair value measurement.
 
During the three and six months ended June 2009, the firm securitized $12.91 billion and $16.47 billion, respectively, of financial assets in which the firm had continuing involvement as of June 2009, including $12.41 billion and $15.88 billion, respectively, of residential mortgages, primarily in connection with government agency securitizations, and $496 million and $591 million, respectively, of other financial assets. During the three and six months ended May 2008, the firm securitized $3.97 billion and $6.54 billion, respectively, of financial assets, including $2.59 billion and $4.11 billion, respectively, of residential mortgages, $773 million and $773 million, respectively, of commercial mortgages, and $605 million and $1.65 billion, respectively, of other financial assets, primarily in connection with CLOs. Cash flows received on retained interests were $106 million and $200 million for the three and six months ended June 2009, respectively, and $155 million and $271 million for the three and six months ended May 2008, respectively.


42


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The following table sets forth certain information related to the firm’s continuing involvement in securitization entities to which the firm sold assets, as well as the total outstanding principal amount of transferred assets in which the firm has continuing involvement, as of June 2009 in accordance with FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8. The outstanding principal amount set forth in the tables below is presented for the purpose of providing information about the size of the securitization entities in which the firm has continuing involvement, and is not representative of the firm’s risk of loss. For retained or purchased interests, the firm’s risk of loss is limited to the fair value of these interests.
 
                         
    As of June 2009 (1)
    Outstanding
  Fair value of
  Fair value of
    principal
  retained
  purchased
   
amount
 
interests
 
interests (2)
    (in millions)
Residential mortgage-backed
  $ 41,352     $ 1,998  (4)   $ 134  
Commercial mortgage-backed
    13,714       236       61  
Other asset-backed (3)
    19,225       113       4  
                         
Total
  $ 74,291     $ 2,347     $ 199  
                         
 
 
(1) As of June 2009, fair value of other continuing involvement excludes $334 million, of purchased interests in securitization entities where the firm’s involvement was related to secondary market-making activities. Continuing involvement also excludes derivative contracts that are used by securitization entities to manage credit, interest rate or foreign exchange risk. See Note 3 for information on the firm’s derivative contracts.
 
(2) Comprised of senior and subordinated interests purchased in connection with secondary market-making activities in VIEs and QSPEs in which the firm also holds retained interests. In addition to these interests, the firm had other continuing involvement in the form of derivative transactions and guarantees with certain VIEs for which the carrying value was a net liability of $253 million as of June 2009. The notional amounts of these transactions are included in maximum exposure to loss in the nonconsolidated VIE table below.
 
(3) Primarily consists of CDOs backed by corporate and mortgage obligations and CLOs. Outstanding principal amount and fair value of retained interests include $18.07 billion and $76 million, respectively, as of June 2009 related to VIEs which are also included in the nonconsolidated VIE table below.
 
(4) Primarily consists of retained interests in government agency QSPEs.


43


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The following table sets forth the weighted average key economic assumptions used in measuring the fair value of the firm’s retained interests and the sensitivity of this fair value to immediate adverse changes of 10% and 20% in those assumptions:
 
                                 
    As of June 2009   As of November 2008
    Type of Retained Interests (1)   Type of Retained Interests (1)
        Other
      Other
    Mortgage-
  Asset-
  Mortgage-
  Asset-
   
Backed
 
Backed (2)
 
Backed
 
Backed
    ($ in millions)
Fair value of retained interests
  $ 2,234     $ 113     $ 1,415     $ 367  (5)
                                 
Weighted average life (years)
    5.2       3.6       6.0       5.1  
                                 
Constant prepayment rate (3)
    19.1 %     N.M.       15.5 %     4.5 %
Impact of 10% adverse change (3)
  $ (20 )     N.M.     $ (14 )   $ (6 )
Impact of 20% adverse change (3)
    (40 )     N.M.       (27 )     (12 )
                                 
Discount rate (4)
    11.3 %     N.M.       21.1 %     29.2 %
Impact of 10% adverse change
  $ (62 )     N.M.     $ (46 )   $ (25 )
Impact of 20% adverse change
    (119 )     N.M.       (89 )     (45 )
 
 
(1) Includes $2.27 billion and $1.53 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, held in QSPEs.
 
(2) Due to the nature and current fair value of certain of these retained interests, the weighted average assumptions for constant prepayment and discount rates and the related sensitivity to adverse changes are not meaningful as of June 2009. The firm’s maximum exposure to adverse changes in the value of these interests is the firm’s carrying value of $113 million.
 
(3) Constant prepayment rate is included only for positions for which constant prepayment rate is a key assumption in the determination of fair value.
 
(4) The majority of the firm’s mortgage-backed retained interests are U.S. government agency-issued collateralized mortgage obligations, for which there is no anticipated credit loss. For the remainder of the firm’s retained interests, the expected credit loss assumptions are reflected within the discount rate.
 
(5) Includes $192 million of retained interests related to transfers of securitized assets that were accounted for as secured financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140.


44


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The preceding table does not give effect to the offsetting benefit of other financial instruments that are held to mitigate risks inherent in these retained interests. Changes in fair value based on an adverse variation in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumptions to the change in fair value is not usually linear. In addition, the impact of a change in a particular assumption is calculated independently of changes in any other assumption. In practice, simultaneous changes in assumptions might magnify or counteract the sensitivities disclosed above.
 
As of June 2009 and November 2008, the firm held mortgage servicing rights with a fair value of $130 million and $147 million, respectively. These servicing assets represent the firm’s right to receive a future stream of cash flows, such as servicing fees, in excess of the firm’s obligation to service residential mortgages. The fair value of mortgage servicing rights will fluctuate in response to changes in certain economic variables, such as discount rates and loan prepayment rates. The firm estimates the fair value of mortgage servicing rights by using valuation models that incorporate these variables in quantifying anticipated cash flows related to servicing activities. Mortgage servicing rights are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The following table sets forth changes in the firm’s mortgage servicing rights, as well as servicing fees earned:
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
        (in millions)    
Balance, beginning of period
  $ 139     $ 283     $ 153     $ 93  
Purchases
                      212  (2)
Servicing assets that resulted from transfers of financial assets
                      3  
Changes in fair value due to changes in valuation inputs and assumptions
    (9 )     (35 )     (23 )     (60 )
                                 
Balance, end of period (1)
  $ 130     $ 248     $ 130     $ 248  
                                 
                                 
Contractually specified servicing fees
  $ 85     $ 72     $ 177     $ 137  
                                 
 
 
(1) As of June 2009, the fair value was estimated using a weighted average discount rate of approximately 16% and a weighted average prepayment rate of approximately 27%. As of May 2008, the fair value was estimated using a weighted average discount rate of approximately 16% and a weighted average prepayment rate of approximately 26%.
 
(2) Primarily related to the acquisition of Litton Loan Servicing LP.


45


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Variable Interest Entities (VIEs)
 
The firm, in the ordinary course of business, retains interests in VIEs in connection with its securitization activities. The firm also purchases and sells variable interests in VIEs, which primarily issue mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securities, CDOs and CLOs, in connection with its market-making activities and makes investments in and loans to VIEs that hold performing and nonperforming debt, equity, real estate, power-related and other assets. In addition, the firm utilizes VIEs to provide investors with principal-protected notes, credit-linked notes and asset-repackaged notes designed to meet their objectives. VIEs generally purchase assets by issuing debt and equity instruments.
 
The firm’s significant variable interests in VIEs include senior and subordinated debt interests in mortgage-backed and asset-backed securitization vehicles, CDOs and CLOs; loan commitments; limited and general partnership interests; preferred and common stock; interest rate, foreign currency, equity, commodity and credit derivatives; and guarantees.
 
The firm’s exposure to the obligations of VIEs is generally limited to its interests in these entities. In the tables set forth below, the maximum exposure to loss for purchased and retained interests and loans and investments is the carrying value of these interests. In certain instances, the firm provides guarantees, including derivative guarantees, to VIEs or holders of variable interests in VIEs. For these contracts, maximum exposure to loss set forth in the tables below is the notional amount of such guarantees, which does not represent anticipated losses and also has not been reduced by unrealized losses already recorded by the firm in connection with these guarantees. As a result, the maximum exposure to loss exceeds the firm’s liabilities related to VIEs.
 
The following tables set forth total assets in firm-sponsored nonconsolidated VIEs in which the firm holds variable interests and other nonconsolidated VIEs in which the firm holds significant variable interests, and the firm’s maximum exposure to loss excluding the benefit of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate the risks associated with these variable interests. For June 2009, in accordance with FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8, the following tables also set forth the total assets and total liabilities included in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition related to the firm’s significant interests in nonconsolidated VIEs. The firm has aggregated nonconsolidated VIEs based on principal business activity, as reflected in the first column. The nature of the firm’s variable interests can take different forms, as described in the columns under maximum exposure to loss.
 
                                                                   
    As of June 2009
          Carrying Value of
   
          the Firm’s
                   
          Variable Interests   Maximum Exposure to Loss in Nonconsolidated VIEs (1)
                  Purchased
  Commitments
           
    Assets
             and Retained
  and
      Loans and
   
    in VIE     Assets   Liabilities   Interests   Guarantees   Derivatives   Investments   Total
                  (in millions)            
Mortgage CDOs (2)
  $ 9,065       $ 108     $     $ 49     $     $ 4,214  (7)   $     $ 4,263  
Corporate CDOs and CLOs (2)
    24,829         495       650       223             6,059  (8)           6,282  
Real estate, credit-related
and other investing (3)
    28,659         2,969       168             347             2,906       3,253  
Other asset-backed (2)
    516         13       17                   516             516  
Power-related (4)
    617         213       3             37             213       250  
Principal-protected notes (5)
    2,459         26       1,654                   2,550             2,550  
                                                                   
Total
  $ 66,145       $ 3,824     $ 2,492     $ 272     $ 384  (6)   $ 13,339  (6)   $ 3,119     $ 17,114  
                                                                   
                                                                   
                                                                   


46


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
                                                   
    As of November 2008
          Maximum Exposure to Loss in Nonconsolidated VIEs (1)
          Purchased
  Commitments
           
    Assets
    and Retained
  and
      Loans and
   
    in VIE     Interests   Guarantees   Derivatives   Investments   Total
    (in millions)
Mortgage CDOs
  $ 13,061       $ 242     $     $ 5,616  (7)   $     $ 5,858  
Corporate CDOs and CLOs
    8,584         161             918  (8)           1,079  
Real estate, credit-related and other investing (3)
    26,898               143             3,223       3,366  
Municipal bond securitizations
    111               111                   111  
Other asset-backed
    4,355                     1,084             1,084  
Power-related
    844               37             213       250  
Principal-protected notes (5)
    4,516                     4,353             4,353  
                                                   
Total
  $ 58,369       $ 403     $ 291     $ 11,971     $ 3,436     $ 16,101  
                                                   
 
 
(1)  Such amounts do not represent the anticipated losses in connection with these transactions as they exclude the effect of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate these risks.
 
(2)  These VIEs are generally financed through the issuance of debt instruments collateralized by assets held by the VIE. Substantially all assets and liabilities held by the firm related to these VIEs are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
 
(3)  The firm obtains interests in these VIEs in connection with making investments in real estate, distressed loans and other types of debt, mezzanine instruments and equities. These VIEs are generally financed through the issuance of debt and equity instruments which are either collateralized by or indexed to assets held by the VIE. Substantially all assets and liabilities held by the firm related to these VIEs are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
 
(4)  Assets and liabilities held by the firm related to these VIEs are included in “Other assets” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
 
(5)  Consists of out-of-the-money written put options that provide principal protection to clients invested in various fund products, with risk to the firm mitigated through portfolio rebalancing. Assets related to these VIEs are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and liabilities related to these VIEs are included in “Other secured financings,” “Unsecured short-term borrowings” or “Unsecured long-term borrowings” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition. Assets in VIE, carrying value of liabilities and maximum exposure to loss exclude $3.70 billion as of June 2009, associated with guarantees related to the firm’s performance under borrowings from the VIE, which are recorded as liabilities in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition. Substantially all of the liabilities included in the table above relate to additional borrowings from the VIE associated with principal protected notes guaranteed by the firm.
 
(6)  The aggregate amounts include $4.95 billion as of June 2009, related to guarantees and derivative transactions with VIEs to which the firm transferred assets.
 
(7)  Primarily consists of written protection on investment-grade, short-term collateral held by VIEs that have issued CDOs.
 
(8)  Primarily consists of total return swaps on CDOs and CLOs. The firm has generally transferred the risks related to the underlying securities through derivatives with non-VIEs.


47


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s total assets excluding the benefit of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate the risks associated with its variable interests in consolidated VIEs. The following table excludes VIEs in which the firm holds a majority voting interest unless the activities of the VIE are primarily related to securitization, asset-backed financings or single-lessee leasing arrangements. For June 2009, in accordance with FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8, the following table also sets forth the total liabilities included in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition related to the firm’s consolidated VIEs. The firm has aggregated consolidated VIEs based on principal business activity, as reflected in the first column.
 
                         
    As of
    June 2009   November 2008
    VIE
  VIE
  VIE
   
Assets (1)
 
Liabilities (1)
 
Assets (1)
    (in millions)
Real estate, credit-related and other investing
  $ 1,154     $ 936  (2)   $ 1,560  
Municipal bond securitizations
    733       922  (3)     985  
CDOs, mortgage-backed and other asset-backed
    626       548  (4)     32  
Foreign exchange and commodities
    298       297  (5)     652  
Principal-protected notes
    207       207  (6)     215  
                         
Total
  $ 3,018     $ 2,910     $ 3,444  
                         
 
 
(1) Consolidated VIE assets and liabilities are presented after intercompany eliminations and include assets financed on a nonrecourse basis. Substantially all VIE assets are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
(2) These VIE liabilities, which are collateralized by the related VIE assets, are included in “Other secured financings” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition and generally do not provide for recourse to the general credit of the firm.
 
(3) These VIE liabilities, which are partially collateralized by the related VIE assets, are included in “Other secured financings” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
 
(4) These VIE liabilities are included in “Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value” and “Other secured financings” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition and generally do not provide for recourse to the general credit of the firm.
 
(5) These VIE liabilities are primarily included in “Trading liabilities, at fair value” on the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
 
(6) These VIE liabilities are included in “Other secured financings” on the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
 
The firm did not have off-balance-sheet commitments to purchase or finance any CDOs held by structured investment vehicles as of June 2009 and November 2008.


48


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 5.   Deposits
 
The following table sets forth deposits as of June 2009 and November 2008:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
U.S. offices (1)
  $ 35,665     $ 23,018  
Non-U.S. offices (2)
    5,792       4,625  
                 
Total
  $ 41,457     $ 27,643  
                 
 
 
(1) Substantially all U.S. deposits were interest-bearing and were held at GS Bank USA.
 
(2) Substantially all non-U.S. deposits were interest-bearing and held at Goldman Sachs Bank (Europe) PLC (GS Bank Europe).
 
Included in the above table are time deposits of $13.01 billion and $8.49 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. The following table sets forth the maturities of time deposits as of June 2009:
 
                         
    As of June 2009
   
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
 
Total
    (in millions)
2009
  $ 3,705     $ 981     $ 4,686  
2010
    1,516       14       1,530  
2011
    1,593             1,593  
2012
    839             839  
2013
    1,783       25       1,808  
2014-thereafter
    2,551             2,551  
                         
Total
  $ 11,987     $ 1,020     $ 13,007  
                         


49


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 6.   Short-Term Borrowings
 
As of June 2009 and November 2008, short-term borrowings were $49.41 billion and $73.89 billion, respectively, comprised of $14.24 billion and $21.23 billion, respectively, included in “Other secured financings” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and $35.17 billion and $52.66 billion, respectively, of unsecured short-term borrowings. See Note 3 for information on other secured financings.
 
Unsecured short-term borrowings include the portion of unsecured long-term borrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder. The firm accounts for promissory notes, commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments at fair value under SFAS No. 155 or SFAS No. 159. Short-term borrowings that are not recorded at fair value are recorded based on the amount of cash received plus accrued interest, and such amounts approximate fair value due to the short-term nature of the obligations.
 
Unsecured short-term borrowings are set forth below:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
Current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings
  $ 16,062     $ 26,281  
Hybrid financial instruments
    8,938       12,086  
Promissory notes (1)
    3,294       6,944  
Commercial paper (2)
    463       1,125  
Other short-term borrowings (3)
    6,416       6,222  
                 
Total (4)
  $ 35,173     $ 52,658  
                 
 
 
(1) Includes $3.28 billion and $3.42 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) under the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (TLGP).
 
(2) Includes $0 and $751 million as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP.
 
(3) Includes $1.11 billion and $0 as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP.
 
(4) The weighted average interest rates for these borrowings, after giving effect to hedging activities, were 1.70% and 3.37% as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, and excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155 or SFAS No. 159.


50


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 7.   Long-Term Borrowings
 
As of June 2009 and November 2008, long-term borrowings were $207.30 billion and $185.68 billion, respectively, comprised of $16.06 billion and $17.46 billion, respectively, included in “Other secured financings” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and $191.24 billion and $168.22 billion, respectively, of unsecured long-term borrowings. See Note 3 for information regarding other secured financings.
 
The firm’s unsecured long-term borrowings extend through 2043 and consist principally of senior borrowings.
 
Unsecured long-term borrowings are set forth below:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
Fixed rate obligations (1)
  $ 118,723     $ 103,825  
Floating rate obligations (2)
    72,519       64,395  
                 
Total (3)
  $ 191,242     $ 168,220  
                 
 
 
(1) As of June 2009 and November 2008, $79.82 billion and $70.08 billion, respectively, of the firm’s fixed rate debt obligations were denominated in U.S. dollars and interest rates ranged from 1.63% to 10.04% and from 3.87% to 10.04%, respectively. As of June 2009 and November 2008, $38.90 billion and $33.75 billion, respectively, of the firm’s fixed rate debt obligations were denominated in non-U.S. dollars and interest rates ranged from 0.67% to 12.65% and from 0.67% to 8.88%, respectively.
 
(2) As of June 2009 and November 2008, $37.77 billion and $32.41 billion, respectively, of the firm’s floating rate debt obligations were denominated in U.S. dollars. As of June 2009 and November 2008, $34.75 billion and $31.99 billion, respectively, of the firm’s floating rate debt obligations were denominated in non-U.S. dollars. Floating interest rates generally are based on LIBOR or the federal funds target rate. Equity-linked and indexed instruments are included in floating rate obligations.
 
(3) Includes $20.75 billion and $0 as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP.
 
Unsecured long-term borrowings by maturity date are set forth below (in millions):
 
         
    As of
    June 2009
2010
  $ 9,303  
2011
    23,766  
2012
    26,453  
2013
    23,088  
2014
    18,055  
2015-thereafter
    90,577  
         
Total (1)(2)
  $ 191,242  
         
 
 
(1) Unsecured long-term borrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder are included as unsecured short-term borrowings in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
(2) Unsecured long-term borrowings that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.


51


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The firm enters into derivative contracts to effectively convert a substantial portion of its unsecured long-term borrowings which are not accounted for at fair value into floating rate obligations. Accordingly, excluding the cumulative impact of changes in the firm’s credit spreads, the carrying value of unsecured long-term borrowings approximated fair value as of June 2009 and November 2008. For unsecured long-term borrowings for which the firm did not elect the fair value option, the cumulative impact due to the widening of the firm’s own credit spreads would be a reduction in the carrying value of total unsecured long-term borrowings of approximately 3% and 9% as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
The effective weighted average interest rates for unsecured long-term borrowings are set forth below:
 
                                 
    As of
    June 2009   November 2008
   
Amount
 
Rate
 
Amount
 
Rate
    ($ in millions)
Fixed rate obligations
  $ 4,225       6.51 %   $ 4,015       4.97 %
Floating rate obligations (1)
    187,017       0.96       164,205       2.66  
                                 
Total (2)
  $ 191,242       1.11     $ 168,220       2.73  
                                 
 
 
(1) Includes fixed rate obligations that have been converted into floating rate obligations through derivative contracts.
 
(2) The weighted average interest rates as of June 2009 and November 2008 excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155 or SFAS No. 159.
 
Subordinated Borrowings
 
Unsecured long-term borrowings included subordinated borrowings with outstanding principal amounts of $19.17 billion and $19.26 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, as set forth below.
 
Junior Subordinated Debt Issued to Trusts in Connection with Fixed-to-Floating and Floating Rate Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities.  In 2007, Group Inc. issued a total of $2.25 billion of remarketable junior subordinated debt to Goldman Sachs Capital II and Goldman Sachs Capital III (APEX Trusts), Delaware statutory trusts that, in turn, issued $2.25 billion of guaranteed perpetual Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities (APEX) to third parties and a de minimis amount of common securities to Group Inc. Group Inc. also entered into contracts with the APEX Trusts to sell $2.25 billion of perpetual non-cumulative preferred stock to be issued by Group Inc. (the stock purchase contracts). The APEX Trusts are wholly owned finance subsidiaries of the firm for regulatory and legal purposes but are not consolidated for accounting purposes.
 
The firm pays interest semi-annually on $1.75 billion of junior subordinated debt issued to Goldman Sachs Capital II at a fixed annual rate of 5.59% and the debt matures on June 1, 2043. The firm pays interest quarterly on $500 million of junior subordinated debt issued to Goldman Sachs Capital III at a rate per annum equal to three-month LIBOR plus 0.57% and the debt matures on September 1, 2043. In addition, the firm makes contract payments at a rate of 0.20% per annum on the stock purchase contracts held by the APEX Trusts. The firm has the right to defer payments on the junior subordinated debt and the stock purchase contracts, subject to limitations, and therefore cause payment on the APEX to be deferred. During any such extension period, the firm will not be permitted to, among other things, pay dividends on or make certain repurchases of its common or preferred stock. The junior subordinated debt is junior in right of payment to all of Group Inc.’s senior indebtedness and all of Group Inc.’s other subordinated borrowings.


52


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
In connection with the APEX issuance, the firm covenanted in favor of certain of its debtholders, who are initially the holders of Group Inc.’s 6.345% Junior Subordinated Debentures due February 15, 2034, that, subject to certain exceptions, the firm would not redeem or purchase (i) Group Inc.’s junior subordinated debt issued to the APEX Trusts prior to the applicable stock purchase date or (ii) APEX or shares of Group Inc.’s Series E or Series F Preferred Stock prior to the date that is ten years after the applicable stock purchase date, unless the applicable redemption or purchase price does not exceed a maximum amount determined by reference to the aggregate amount of net cash proceeds that the firm has received from the sale of qualifying equity securities during the 180-day period preceding the redemption or purchase.
 
The firm has accounted for the stock purchase contracts as equity instruments under EITF Issue No. 00-19, “Accounting for Derivative Financial Instruments Indexed to, and Potentially Settled in, a Company’s Own Stock,” and, accordingly, recorded the cost of the stock purchase contracts as a reduction to additional paid-in capital. See Note 9 for information on the preferred stock that Group Inc. will issue in connection with the stock purchase contracts.
 
Junior Subordinated Debt Issued to a Trust in Connection with Trust Preferred Securities.  Group Inc. issued $2.84 billion of junior subordinated debentures in 2004 to Goldman Sachs Capital I (Trust), a Delaware statutory trust that, in turn, issued $2.75 billion of guaranteed preferred beneficial interests to third parties and $85 million of common beneficial interests to Group Inc. and invested the proceeds from the sale in junior subordinated debentures issued by Group Inc. The Trust is a wholly owned finance subsidiary of the firm for regulatory and legal purposes but is not consolidated for accounting purposes.
 
The firm pays interest semi-annually on these debentures at an annual rate of 6.345% and the debentures mature on February 15, 2034. The coupon rate and the payment dates applicable to the beneficial interests are the same as the interest rate and payment dates applicable to the debentures. The firm has the right, from time to time, to defer payment of interest on the debentures, and, therefore, cause payment on the Trust’s preferred beneficial interests to be deferred, in each case up to ten consecutive semi-annual periods. During any such extension period, the firm will not be permitted to, among other things, pay dividends on or make certain repurchases of its common stock. The Trust is not permitted to pay any distributions on the common beneficial interests held by Group Inc. unless all dividends payable on the preferred beneficial interests have been paid in full. These debentures are junior in right of payment to all of Group Inc.’s senior indebtedness and all of Group Inc.’s subordinated borrowings, other than the junior subordinated debt issued in connection with the Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities.
 
Subordinated Debt.  As of June 2009, the firm had $14.08 billion of other subordinated debt outstanding with maturities ranging from fiscal 2010 to 2038. The effective weighted average interest rate on this debt was 0.53%, after giving effect to derivative contracts used to convert fixed rate obligations into floating rate obligations. As of November 2008, the firm had $14.17 billion of other subordinated debt outstanding with maturities ranging from fiscal 2009 to 2038. The effective weighted average interest rate on this debt was 1.99%, after giving effect to derivative contracts used to convert fixed rate obligations into floating rate obligations. This debt is junior in right of payment to all of the firm’s senior indebtedness.


53


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 8.   Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees
 
Commitments
 
The following table summarizes the firm’s commitments as of June 2009 and November 2008:
 
                                                 
    Commitment Amount by Fiscal Period
   
    of Expiration as of June 2009   Total Commitments as of
    Remainder
  2010-
  2012-
  2014-
  June
  November
   
of 2009
  2011   2013  
Thereafter
  2009   2008
    (in millions)
Commitments to extend credit (1)
                                               
Commercial lending:
                                               
Investment-grade
  $ 990     $ 4,675     $ 2,181     $ 75     $ 7,921     $ 8,007  
Non-investment-grade (2)
    921       1,933       4,309       349       7,512       9,318  
William Street program
    1,441       9,290       13,009       439       24,179       22,610  
Warehouse financing
    292       40                   332       1,101  
                                                 
Total commitments to extend credit
    3,644       15,938       19,499       863       39,944       41,036  
Forward starting resale and securities borrowing agreements
    57,373       1,201                   58,574       61,455  
Forward starting repurchase and securities lending agreements
    12,638                         12,638       6,948  
Underwriting commitments
    1,858                         1,858       241  
Letters of credit (3)
    2,890       564       179       1       3,634       7,251  
Investment commitments (4)
    2,112       10,598       110       903       13,723       14,266  
Construction-related commitments (5)
    340       50                   390       483  
Other
    130       97       27       24       278       260  
                                                 
Total commitments
  $ 80,985     $ 28,448     $ 19,815     $ 1,791     $ 131,039     $ 131,940  
                                                 
 
 
(1)  Commitments to extend credit are presented net of amounts syndicated to third parties.
 
(2)  Included within non-investment-grade commitments as of June 2009 and November 2008 were $1.31 billion and $2.07 billion, respectively, related to leveraged lending capital market transactions; $105 million and $164 million, respectively, related to commercial real estate transactions; and $6.09 billion and $7.09 billion, respectively, arising from other unfunded credit facilities. Including funded loans, the total notional amount of the firm’s leveraged lending capital market transactions was $5.38 billion and $7.97 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(3)  Consists of commitments under letters of credit issued by various banks which the firm provides to counterparties in lieu of securities or cash to satisfy various collateral and margin deposit requirements.
 
(4)  Consists of the firm’s commitments to invest in private equity, real estate and other assets directly and through funds that the firm raises and manages in connection with its merchant banking and other investing activities, consisting of $3.09 billion and $3.15 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, related to real estate private investments and $10.63 billion and $11.12 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, related to corporate and other private investments. Such commitments include $12.21 billion and $12.25 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, of commitments to invest in funds managed by the firm, which will be funded at market value on the date of investment.
 
(5)  Includes commitments of $348 million and $388 million as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, related to the firm’s new headquarters in New York City, which is expected to cost between $2.05 billion and $2.15 billion. The firm has partially financed this construction project with $1.65 billion of tax-exempt Liberty Bonds.


54


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Commitments to Extend Credit.  The firm’s commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to counterparties that have fixed termination dates and are contingent on the satisfaction of all conditions to borrowing set forth in the contract. Since these commitments may expire unused or be reduced or cancelled at the counterparty’s request, the total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect the actual future cash flow requirements. The firm accounts for these commitments at fair value. To the extent that the firm recognizes losses on these commitments, such losses are recorded within the firm’s Trading and Principal Investments segment net of any related underwriting fees.
 
  •  Commercial lending commitments.  The firm’s commercial lending commitments are generally extended in connection with contingent acquisition financing and other types of corporate lending as well as commercial real estate financing. The total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect the actual future cash flow requirements, as the firm may syndicate all or substantial portions of these commitments in the future, the commitments may expire unused, or the commitments may be cancelled or reduced at the request of the counterparty. In addition, commitments that are extended for contingent acquisition financing are often intended to be short-term in nature, as borrowers often seek to replace them with other funding sources.
 
  •  William Street program.  Substantially all of the commitments provided under the William Street credit extension program are to investment-grade corporate borrowers. Commitments under the program are principally extended by William Street Commitment Corporation (Commitment Corp.), a consolidated wholly owned subsidiary of GS Bank USA, GS Bank USA and other subsidiaries of GS Bank USA. The commitments extended by Commitment Corp. are supported, in part, by funding raised by William Street Funding Corporation (Funding Corp.), another consolidated wholly owned subsidiary of GS Bank USA. The assets and liabilities of Commitment Corp. and Funding Corp. are legally separated from other assets and liabilities of the firm. The assets of Commitment Corp. and of Funding Corp. will not be available to their respective shareholders until the claims of their respective creditors have been paid. In addition, no affiliate of either Commitment Corp. or Funding Corp., except in limited cases as expressly agreed in writing, is responsible for any obligation of either entity. With respect to most of the William Street commitments, Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. (SMFG) provides the firm with credit loss protection that is generally limited to 95% of the first loss the firm realizes on approved loan commitments, up to a maximum of $1.00 billion. In addition, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, upon the firm’s request, SMFG will provide protection for 70% of additional losses on such commitments, up to a maximum of $1.13 billion, of which $375 million of protection has been provided as of June 2009 and November 2008. The firm also uses other financial instruments to mitigate credit risks related to certain William Street commitments not covered by SMFG.
 
  •  Warehouse financing.  The firm provides financing for the warehousing of financial assets. These arrangements are secured by the warehoused assets, primarily consisting of commercial mortgages as of June 2009 and November 2008.


55


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Leases.  The firm has contractual obligations under long-term noncancelable lease agreements, principally for office space, expiring on various dates through 2069. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation provisions for increases in real estate taxes and other charges. Future minimum rental payments, net of minimum sublease rentals are set forth below (in millions):
 
         
Remainder of 2009
  $ 249  
2010
    466  
2011
    360  
2012
    299  
2013
    271  
2014-thereafter
    1,780  
         
Total
  $ 3,425  
         
 
Contingencies
 
The firm is involved in a number of judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of its businesses. Management believes, based on currently available information, that the results of such proceedings, in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the firm’s financial condition, but may be material to the firm’s operating results for any particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for such period. Given the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of the firm’s litigation and regulatory matters, particularly in cases or proceedings in which substantial or indeterminate damages or fines are sought, the firm cannot estimate losses or ranges of losses for cases or proceedings where there is only a reasonable possibility that a loss may be incurred.
 
In connection with its insurance business, the firm is contingently liable to provide guaranteed minimum death and income benefits to certain contract holders and has established a reserve related to $6.09 billion and $6.13 billion of contract holder account balances as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, for such benefits. The weighted average attained age of these contract holders was 68 years as of both June 2009 and November 2008. The net amount at risk, representing guaranteed minimum death and income benefits in excess of contract holder account balances, was $2.49 billion and $2.96 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. See Note 12 for more information on the firm’s insurance liabilities.
 
Guarantees
 
The firm enters into various derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee under FIN 45, “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others,” as amended by FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4.
 
FIN 45 does not require disclosures about derivative contracts if such contracts may be cash settled and the firm has no basis to conclude it is probable that the counterparties held, at inception, the underlying instruments related to the derivative contracts. The firm has concluded that these conditions have been met for certain large, internationally active commercial and investment bank counterparties and certain other counterparties. Accordingly, the firm has not included such contracts in the tables below.
 
The firm, in its capacity as an agency lender, indemnifies most of its securities lending customers against losses incurred in the event that borrowers do not return securities and the collateral held is insufficient to cover the market value of the securities borrowed.


56


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
In the ordinary course of business, the firm provides other financial guarantees of the obligations of third parties (e.g., performance bonds, standby letters of credit and other guarantees to enable clients to complete transactions and merchant banking fund-related guarantees). These guarantees represent obligations to make payments to beneficiaries if the guaranteed party fails to fulfill its obligation under a contractual arrangement with that beneficiary.
 
The following table sets forth certain information about the firm’s derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee and certain other guarantees as of June 2009 and November 2008. Derivative contracts set forth below include written equity and commodity put options, written currency contracts and interest rate caps, floors and swaptions. See Note 3 for information regarding credit derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee, which are not included below.
 
                                                 
        Maximum Payout/
        Notional Amount by Period of Expiration (1)
    Carrying
      2010-
  2012-
  2014-
   
   
Value
  2009   2011   2013  
Thereafter
  Total
    (in millions)
As of June 2009
                                               
Derivatives (2)
  $ 7,548     $ 54,434     $ 103,668     $ 53,300     $ 79,521     $ 290,923  
Securities lending indemnifications (3)
          22,674                         22,674  
Other financial guarantees
    229       207       325       463       1,029       2,024  
                                                 
                                                 
As of November 2008
                                               
Derivatives (2)
  $ 17,462     $ 114,863     $ 73,224     $ 30,312     $ 90,643     $ 309,042  
Securities lending indemnifications (3)
          19,306                         19,306  
Other financial guarantees
    235       203       477       458       238       1,376  
 
 
(1) Such amounts do not represent the anticipated losses in connection with these contracts.
 
(2) Because derivative contracts are accounted for at fair value, carrying value is considered the best indication of payment/performance risk for individual contracts. However, the carrying value excludes the effect of a legal right of setoff that may exist under an enforceable netting agreement and the effect of netting of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements. These derivative contracts are risk managed together with derivative contracts that are not considered guarantees under FIN 45 and, therefore, these amounts do not reflect the firm’s overall risk related to its derivative activities.
 
(3) Collateral held by the lenders in connection with securities lending indemnifications was $23.35 billion and $19.95 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. Because the contractual nature of these arrangements requires the firm to obtain collateral with a market value that exceeds the value of the securities on loan from the borrower, there is minimal performance risk associated with these guarantees.
 
The firm has established trusts, including Goldman Sachs Capital I, II and III, and other entities for the limited purpose of issuing securities to third parties, lending the proceeds to the firm and entering into contractual arrangements with the firm and third parties related to this purpose. See Note 7 for information regarding the transactions involving Goldman Sachs Capital I, II and III. The firm effectively provides for the full and unconditional guarantee of the securities issued by these entities, which are not consolidated for accounting purposes. Timely payment by the firm of amounts due to these entities under the borrowing, preferred stock and related contractual arrangements will be sufficient to cover payments due on the securities issued by these entities. Management believes that it is unlikely that any circumstances will occur, such as nonperformance on the part of paying agents or other service providers, that would make it necessary for the firm to make payments related to these entities other than those required under the terms of the borrowing, preferred stock and related contractual arrangements and in connection with certain expenses incurred by these entities. Group Inc. also fully and unconditionally guarantees the securities issued by GS Finance Corp., a wholly owned finance subsidiary of the firm, which is consolidated for accounting purposes.


57


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
In the ordinary course of business, the firm indemnifies and guarantees certain service providers, such as clearing and custody agents, trustees and administrators, against specified potential losses in connection with their acting as an agent of, or providing services to, the firm or its affiliates. The firm also indemnifies some clients against potential losses incurred in the event specified third-party service providers, including sub-custodians and third-party brokers, improperly execute transactions. In addition, the firm is a member of payment, clearing and settlement networks as well as securities exchanges around the world that may require the firm to meet the obligations of such networks and exchanges in the event of member defaults. In connection with its prime brokerage and clearing businesses, the firm agrees to clear and settle on behalf of its clients the transactions entered into by them with other brokerage firms. The firm’s obligations in respect of such transactions are secured by the assets in the client’s account as well as any proceeds received from the transactions cleared and settled by the firm on behalf of the client. In connection with joint venture investments, the firm may issue loan guarantees under which it may be liable in the event of fraud, misappropriation, environmental liabilities and certain other matters involving the borrower. The firm is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under these guarantees and indemnifications. However, management believes that it is unlikely the firm will have to make any material payments under these arrangements, and no liabilities related to these guarantees and indemnifications have been recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition as of June 2009 and November 2008.
 
The firm provides representations and warranties to counterparties in connection with a variety of commercial transactions and occasionally indemnifies them against potential losses caused by the breach of those representations and warranties. The firm may also provide indemnifications protecting against changes in or adverse application of certain U.S. tax laws in connection with ordinary-course transactions such as securities issuances, borrowings or derivatives. In addition, the firm may provide indemnifications to some counterparties to protect them in the event additional taxes are owed or payments are withheld, due either to a change in or an adverse application of certain non-U.S. tax laws. These indemnifications generally are standard contractual terms and are entered into in the ordinary course of business. Generally, there are no stated or notional amounts included in these indemnifications, and the contingencies triggering the obligation to indemnify are not expected to occur. The firm is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under these guarantees and indemnifications. However, management believes that it is unlikely the firm will have to make any material payments under these arrangements, and no liabilities related to these arrangements have been recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition as of June 2009 and November 2008.
 
Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of Goldman, Sachs & Co. (GS&Co.), GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe, subject to certain exceptions. In November 2008, the firm contributed subsidiaries into GS Bank USA, and Group Inc. agreed to guarantee certain losses, including credit-related losses, relating to assets held by the contributed entities. In connection with this guarantee, Group Inc. also agreed to pledge to GS Bank USA certain collateral, including interests in subsidiaries and other illiquid assets. In addition, Group Inc. guarantees many of the obligations of its other consolidated subsidiaries on a transaction-by-transaction basis, as negotiated with counterparties. Group Inc. is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under its subsidiary guarantees; however, because these guaranteed obligations are also obligations of consolidated subsidiaries included in the table above, Group Inc.’s liabilities as guarantor are not separately disclosed.


58


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 9.   Shareholders’ Equity
 
Common and Preferred Equity
 
During the second quarter of 2009, Group Inc. completed a public offering of 46.7 million common shares at $123.00 per share for total proceeds of $5.75 billion.
 
In June 2009, Group Inc. repurchased from the U.S. Department of the Treasury (U.S. Treasury) the 10.0 million shares of the Company’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series H (Series H Preferred Stock), that were issued to the U.S. Treasury pursuant to the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program. The aggregate purchase price paid by Group Inc. to the U.S. Treasury for the Series H Preferred Stock, including accrued dividends, was $10.04 billion. The repurchase resulted in a one-time preferred dividend of $426 million, which is included in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings for the three and six months ended June 2009. This one-time preferred dividend represented the difference between the carrying value and the redemption value of the Series H Preferred Stock. In connection with the issuance of the Series H Preferred Stock in October 2008, the firm issued a 10-year warrant to the U.S. Treasury to purchase up to 12.2 million shares of common stock at an exercise price of $122.90 per share. See Note 18 for information regarding Group Inc.’s repurchase of this warrant in July 2009.
 
On July 13, 2009, the Board declared a dividend of $0.35 per common share to be paid on September 24, 2009 to common shareholders of record on August 25, 2009.
 
To satisfy minimum statutory employee tax withholding requirements related to the delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units, the firm cancelled 11.1 million of restricted stock units with a total value of $849 million in the first half of 2009.
 
The firm’s share repurchase program is intended to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity and to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employee share-based compensation. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by the firm’s current and projected capital positions (i.e., comparisons of the firm’s desired level of capital to its actual level of capital) but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of the firm’s common stock. Upon repurchase of the Series H Preferred Stock in June 2009, the Company was no longer subject to the limitations on common stock repurchases imposed under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program.
 
As of June 2009, the firm had 174,000 shares of perpetual preferred stock issued and outstanding as set forth in the following table:
 
                                     
                        Redemption
    Dividend
  Shares
  Shares
      Earliest
  Value
Series
  Preference  
Issued
 
Authorized
  Dividend Rate  
Redemption Date
 
(in millions)
A
  Non-cumulative     30,000       50,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.75%,
with floor of 3.75% per annum
  April 25, 2010   $ 750  
                                     
B
  Non-cumulative     32,000       50,000     6.20% per annum   October 31, 2010     800  
                                     
C
  Non-cumulative     8,000       25,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.75%,
with floor of 4.00% per annum
  October 31, 2010     200  
                                     
D
  Non-cumulative     54,000       60,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.67%,
with floor of 4.00% per annum
  May 24, 2011     1,350  
                                     
G
  Cumulative     50,000       50,000     10.00% per annum   Date of issuance     5,500  
                                     
          174,000       235,000             $ 8,600  
                                     


59


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Each share of non-cumulative preferred stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $25,000, is represented by 1,000 depositary shares and is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to the approval of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board), at a redemption price equal to $25,000 plus declared and unpaid dividends.
 
Each share of Series G Preferred Stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $100,000 and is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption price equal to $110,000 plus accrued and unpaid dividends. In connection with the issuance of the Series G Preferred Stock, the firm issued a five-year warrant to purchase up to 43.5 million shares of common stock at an exercise price of $115.00 per share. The warrant is exercisable at any time until October 1, 2013 and the number of shares of common stock underlying the warrant and the exercise price are subject to adjustment for certain dilutive events.
 
All series of preferred stock are pari passu and have a preference over the firm’s common stock upon liquidation. Dividends on each series of preferred stock, if declared, are payable quarterly in arrears. The firm’s ability to declare or pay dividends on, or purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, its common stock is subject to certain restrictions in the event that the firm fails to pay or set aside full dividends on the preferred stock for the latest completed dividend period.
 
In 2007, the Board authorized 17,500.1 shares of perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series E, and 5,000.1 shares of perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series F, in connection with the APEX issuance. See Note 7 for further information on the APEX issuance. Under the stock purchase contracts, Group Inc. will issue on the relevant stock purchase dates (on or before June 1, 2013 and September 1, 2013 for Series E and Series F preferred stock, respectively) one share of Series E and Series F preferred stock to Goldman Sachs Capital II and III, respectively, for each $100,000 principal amount of subordinated debt held by these trusts. When issued, each share of Series E and Series F preferred stock will have a par value of $0.01 and a liquidation preference of $100,000 per share. Dividends on Series E preferred stock, if declared, will be payable semi-annually at a fixed annual rate of 5.79% if the stock is issued prior to June 1, 2012 and quarterly thereafter, at a rate per annum equal to the greater of (i) three-month LIBOR plus 0.77% and (ii) 4.00%. Dividends on Series F preferred stock, if declared, will be payable quarterly at a rate per annum equal to three-month LIBOR plus 0.77% if the stock is issued prior to September 1, 2012 and quarterly thereafter, at a rate per annum equal to the greater of (i) three-month LIBOR plus 0.77% and (ii) 4.00%. The preferred stock may be redeemed at the option of the firm on the stock purchase dates or any day thereafter, subject to regulatory approval and certain covenant restrictions governing the firm’s ability to redeem or purchase the preferred stock without issuing common stock or other instruments with equity-like characteristics.
 
On July 13, 2009, the Board declared dividends of $236.98, $387.50, $252.78 and $252.78 per share of Series A Preferred Stock, Series B Preferred Stock, Series C Preferred Stock and Series D Preferred Stock, respectively, to be paid on August 10, 2009 to preferred shareholders of record on July 26, 2009. In addition, the Board declared a dividend of $2,500 per share of Series G Preferred Stock to be paid on August 10, 2009 to preferred shareholders of record on July 26, 2009.


60


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Other Comprehensive Income
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) by type:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
Adjustment from adoption of SFAS No. 158, net of tax
  $ (194 )   $ (194 )
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
    (91 )     (30 )
Pension and postretirement liability adjustment, net of tax
    (89 )     69  
Net unrealized gains/(losses) on available-for-sale securities, net of tax (1)
    24       (47 )
                 
Total accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax
  $ (350 )   $ (202 )
                 
 
 
(1) Consists of net unrealized gains/(losses) of $17 million and $(55) million on available-for-sale securities held by the firm’s insurance subsidiaries as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, and net unrealized gains of $7 million and $8 million on available-for-sale securities held by investees accounted for under the equity method as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
Note 10.   Earnings Per Common Share
 
The computations of basic and diluted earnings per common share are set forth below:
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions, except per share amounts)
Numerator for basic and diluted EPS — net earnings applicable to common shareholders
  $ 2,718     $ 2,051     $ 4,377     $ 3,518  
                                 
Denominator for basic EPS — weighted average number of common shares
    514.1       427.5       495.7       430.3  
Effect of dilutive securities (1)
                               
Restricted stock units
    15.8       9.6       12.6       9.1  
Stock options and warrants
    21.1       10.3       11.8       11.2  
                                 
Dilutive potential common shares
    36.9       19.9       24.4       20.3  
                                 
Denominator for diluted EPS — weighted average number of common shares and dilutive potential common shares
    551.0       447.4       520.1       450.6  
                                 
Basic EPS (2)
  $ 5.27     $ 4.80     $ 8.81     $ 8.18  
Diluted EPS (2)
    4.93       4.58       8.42       7.81  
 
 
(1) The diluted EPS computations do not include the antidilutive effect of restricted stock units (RSUs), stock options and warrants as follows:
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
 
Number of antidilutive RSUs and common shares underlying antidilutive stock options and warrants
    14.3       6.4       53.3       7.0  
                                 
 
(2) In accordance with FSP No. EITF 03-6-1, unvested share-based payment awards that have non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents are to be treated as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share. The firm adopted the FSP in the first quarter of fiscal 2009. The impact to basic earnings per common share for the three and six months ended June 2009 was a reduction of $0.02 per common share. There was no impact on diluted earnings per common share. Prior periods have not been restated due to immateriality.


61


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 11.   Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
Goodwill
 
The following table sets forth the carrying value of the firm’s goodwill by operating segment, which is included in “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
Investment Banking
               
Underwriting
  $ 125     $ 125  
Trading and Principal Investments
               
FICC
    256       247  
Equities (1)
    2,389       2,389  
Principal Investments
    84       80  
Asset Management and Securities Services
               
Asset Management (2)
    565       565  
Securities Services
    117       117  
                 
Total
  $ 3,536     $ 3,523  
                 
 
 
(1) Primarily related to SLK LLC (SLK).
 
(2) Primarily related to The Ayco Company, L.P. (Ayco).


62


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
The following table sets forth the gross carrying amount, accumulated amortization and net carrying amount of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets:
 
                     
        As of
        June
  November
        2009   2008
        (in millions)
 
Customer lists (1)
  Gross carrying amount   $ 1,116     $ 1,160  
    Accumulated amortization     (438 )     (436 )
                     
    Net carrying amount   $ 678     $ 724  
                     
New York Stock
  Gross carrying amount   $ 714     $ 714  
Exchange (NYSE)
  Accumulated amortization     (274 )     (252 )
                     
DMM rights
  Net carrying amount   $ 440     $ 462  
                     
Insurance-related
  Gross carrying amount   $ 292     $ 292  
assets (2)
  Accumulated amortization     (167 )     (137 )
                     
    Net carrying amount   $ 125     $ 155  
                     
Exchange-traded
  Gross carrying amount   $ 138     $ 138  
fund (ETF) lead
  Accumulated amortization     (46 )     (43 )
                     
market maker rights
  Net carrying amount   $ 92     $ 95  
                     
Other (3)
  Gross carrying amount   $ 195     $ 178  
    Accumulated amortization     (93 )     (85 )
                     
    Net carrying amount   $ 102     $ 93  
                     
Total
  Gross carrying amount   $ 2,455     $ 2,482  
    Accumulated amortization     (1,018 )     (953 )
                     
    Net carrying amount   $ 1,437     $ 1,529  
                     
 
 
(1) Primarily includes the firm’s clearance and execution and NASDAQ customer lists related to SLK and financial counseling customer lists related to Ayco.
 
(2) Primarily includes VOBA related to the firm’s insurance businesses.
 
(3) Primarily includes marketing-related assets and other contractual rights.
 
Substantially all of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets are considered to have finite lives and are amortized over their estimated lives. The weighted average remaining life of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets is approximately 11 years.


63


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The estimated future amortization for existing identifiable intangible assets through 2014 is set forth below (in millions):
 
         
Remainder of 2009
  $ 72  
2010
    137  
2011
    133  
2012
    125  
2013
    119  
2014
    116  
 
Note 12.   Other Assets and Other Liabilities
 
Other Assets
 
Other assets are generally less liquid, non-financial assets. The following table sets forth the firm’s other assets by type:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment (1)
  $ 10,925     $ 10,793  
Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets (2)
    4,973       5,052  
Income tax-related assets
    7,829       8,359  
Equity-method investments (3)
    1,425       1,454  
Miscellaneous receivables and other
    3,953       4,780  
                 
Total
  $ 29,105     $ 30,438  
                 
 
 
(1) Net of accumulated depreciation and amortization of $7.67 billion and $6.55 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(2) See Note 11 for further information regarding the firm’s goodwill and identifiable intangible assets.
 
(3) Excludes investments of $2.81 billion and $3.45 billion accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159 as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, which are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.


64


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Other Liabilities
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s other liabilities and accrued expenses by type:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
Compensation and benefits
  $ 10,178     $ 4,646  
Insurance-related liabilities (1)
    11,851       9,673  
Noncontrolling interests (2)
    938       1,127  
Income tax-related liabilities
    3,010       2,865  
Employee interests in consolidated funds
    438       517  
Accrued expenses and other payables
    5,198       4,388  
                 
Total
  $ 31,613     $ 23,216  
                 
 
 
(1) Insurance-related liabilities are set forth in the table below:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
 
Separate account liabilities
  $ 3,808     $ 3,628  
Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims
    6,895       4,778  
Contract holder account balances
    812       899  
Reserves for guaranteed minimum death and income benefits
    336       368  
                 
Total insurance-related liabilities
  $ 11,851     $ 9,673  
                 
 
Separate account liabilities are supported by separate account assets, representing segregated contract holder funds under variable annuity and life insurance contracts. Separate account assets are included in “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims include liabilities arising from reinsurance provided by the firm to other insurers. The firm had a receivable for $1.32 billion and $1.30 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, related to such reinsurance contracts, which is reported in “Receivables from customers and counterparties” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. In addition, the firm has ceded risks to reinsurers related to certain of its liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims and had a receivable of $1.35 billion and $1.20 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, related to such reinsurance contracts, which is reported in “Receivables from customers and counterparties” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. Contracts to cede risks to reinsurers do not relieve the firm from its obligations to contract holders. Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims include $2.10 billion and $978 million carried at fair value under SFAS No. 159 as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
Reserves for guaranteed minimum death and income benefits represent a liability for the expected value of guaranteed benefits in excess of projected annuity account balances. These reserves are computed in accordance with AICPA SOP 03-1 and are based on total payments expected to be made less total fees expected to be assessed over the life of the contract.
 
(2) Includes $601 million and $784 million related to consolidated investment funds as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.


65


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 13.   Transactions with Affiliated Funds
 
The firm has formed numerous nonconsolidated investment funds with third-party investors. The firm generally acts as the investment manager for these funds and, as such, is entitled to receive management fees and, in certain cases, advisory fees, incentive fees or overrides from these funds. These fees amounted to $1.19 billion and $1.76 billion for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively. As of June 2009 and November 2008, the fees receivable from these funds were $908 million and $861 million, respectively. Additionally, the firm may invest alongside the third-party investors in certain funds. The aggregate carrying value of the firm’s interests in these funds was $12.82 billion and $14.45 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. In the ordinary course of business, the firm may also engage in other activities with these funds, including, among others, securities lending, trade execution, trading, custody, and acquisition and bridge financing. See Note 8 for the firm’s commitments related to these funds.
 
Note 14.   Income Taxes
 
The firm is subject to examination by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (IRS) and other taxing authorities in jurisdictions where the firm has significant business operations, such as the United Kingdom, Japan, Hong Kong, Korea and various states, such as New York. The tax years under examination vary by jurisdiction. The firm does not expect unrecognized tax benefits to change significantly during the twelve months subsequent to June 2009.
 
Below is a table of the earliest tax years that remain subject to examination by major jurisdiction:
 
         
    Earliest
    Tax Year
    Subject to
Jurisdiction
 
Examination
U.S. Federal
    2005  (1)
New York State and City
    2004  (2)
United Kingdom
    2005  
Japan
    2005  
Hong Kong
    2003  
Korea
    2003  
 
 
(1) IRS examination of fiscal 2005, 2006 and 2007 began during 2008. IRS examination of fiscal 2003 and 2004 has been completed but the liabilities for those years are not yet final.
 
(2) New York State and City examination of fiscal 2004, 2005 and 2006 began in 2008. New York State examinations of fiscal 1999 through 2003 have been completed but the liabilities for those years are not yet final.
 
All years subsequent to the above years remain open to examination by the taxing authorities. The firm believes that the liability for unrecognized tax benefits it has established is adequate in relation to the potential for additional assessments. The resolution of tax matters is not expected to have a material effect on the firm’s financial condition but may be material to the firm’s operating results for a particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for that period.


66


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 15.   Regulation and Capital Adequacy
 
The Federal Reserve Board is the primary U.S. regulator of Group Inc. As a bank holding company, the firm is subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve Board. The firm’s bank depository institution subsidiaries, including GS Bank USA, are subject to similar capital requirements. Under the Federal Reserve Board’s capital adequacy requirements and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action (PCA) that is applicable to GS Bank USA, the firm and its bank depository institution subsidiaries must meet specific capital requirements that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory reporting practices. The firm and its bank depository institution subsidiaries’ capital levels, as well as GS Bank USA’s PCA classification, are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.
 
Many of the firm’s subsidiaries, including GS&Co. and the firm’s other broker-dealer subsidiaries, are subject to separate regulation and capital requirements as described below.
 
The following table sets forth information regarding Group Inc.’s capital ratios as of June 2009 calculated in accordance with the Federal Reserve Board’s regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies, which are based on the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel I). These ratios are used by the Federal Reserve Board and other U.S. Federal banking agencies in the supervisory review process, including the assessment of the firm’s capital adequacy. The calculation of these ratios includes certain market risk measures that are under review by the Federal Reserve Board, as part of Group Inc.’s transition to bank holding company status. The calculation of these ratios has not been reviewed with the Federal Reserve Board and, accordingly, these ratios may be revised in subsequent filings.
 
         
    As of
    June 2009
    ($ in millions)
Tier 1 Capital
       
Common shareholders’ equity
  $ 55,856  
Preferred stock
    6,957  
Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts
    5,000  
Less: Goodwill
    (3,536 )
Less: Disallowable intangible assets
    (1,437 )
Less: Other deductions (1)
    (6,297 )
         
Tier 1 Capital
    56,543  
Tier 2 Capital
       
Qualifying subordinated debt (2)
    13,989  
Less: Other deductions (1)
    (160 )
         
Tier 2 Capital
  $ 13,829  
         
Total Capital
  $ 70,372  
         
Risk-Weighted Assets
  $ 409,204  
         
Tier 1 Capital Ratio
    13.8 %
Total Capital Ratio
    17.2 %
Tier 1 Leverage Ratio
    6.4 %
 
 
(1) Principally includes equity investments in non-financial companies and the cumulative change in the fair value of the firm’s unsecured borrowings attributable to the impact of changes in the firm’s own credit spreads, disallowed deferred tax assets, and investments in certain nonconsolidating entities.
 
(2) Substantially all of the firm’s existing subordinated debt qualifies as Tier 2 capital for Basel I purposes.


67


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Risk-Weighted Assets (RWAs) under the Federal Reserve Board’s risk-based capital guidelines are comprised of requirements for market risk and credit risk. RWAs for market risk include certain measures that are under review by the Federal Reserve Board as part of Group Inc.’s transition to bank holding company status. Credit risk RWAs for on-balance sheet assets are based on the balance sheet value. For off-balance sheet exposures, including OTC derivatives and commitments, a credit equivalent amount is calculated based on the notional of each trade. All such assets and amounts are then assigned a risk weight depending on whether the counterparty is a sovereign, bank or qualifying securities firm, or other entity (or where collateral is held, the risk weight will depend on the nature of such collateral).
 
The firm’s Tier 1 leverage ratio is defined as Tier 1 capital under Basel I divided by adjusted average total assets (which includes adjustments for disallowed goodwill and certain intangible assets).
 
Federal Reserve Board regulations require bank holding companies to maintain a minimum Tier 1 capital ratio of 4% and a minimum total capital ratio of 8%. The required minimum Tier 1 capital ratio and total capital ratio in order to be considered a “well capitalized” bank holding company under the Federal Reserve Board guidelines are 6% and 10%, respectively. Bank holding companies may be expected to maintain ratios well above the minimum levels, depending upon their particular condition, risk profile and growth plans. The minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio is 3% for bank holding companies that have received the highest supervisory rating under Federal Reserve Board guidelines or that have implemented the Federal Reserve Board’s capital measure for market risk. Other bank holding companies must have a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio of 4%.
 
The firm also continues to disclose its capital ratios in accordance with the capital guidelines applicable to it before it became a bank holding company in September 2008, when the firm was regulated by the SEC as a Consolidated Supervised Entity (CSE). These guidelines were generally consistent with those set out in the Revised Framework for the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel II). Subsequent to becoming a bank holding company, the firm no longer reports the CSE capital ratios to the SEC and Group Inc. is no longer regulated as a CSE.


68


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The following table sets forth information regarding Group Inc.’s capital ratios as of June 2009 and November 2008 calculated in the same manner (generally consistent with Basel II) as when the firm was regulated by the SEC as a CSE:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    ($ in millions)
I. Tier 1 and Total Allowable Capital
               
Common shareholders’ equity
  $ 55,856     $ 47,898  
Preferred stock
    6,957       16,471  
Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts
    5,000       5,000  
Less: Goodwill
    (3,536 )     (3,523 )
Less: Disallowable intangible assets
    (1,437 )     (1,386 )
Less: Other deductions (1)
    (1,322 )     (1,823 )
                 
Tier 1 Capital
    61,518       62,637  
Other components of Total Allowable Capital
               
Qualifying subordinated debt (2)
    13,989       13,703  
Less: Other deductions (1)
    (160 )     (690 )
                 
Total Allowable Capital
  $ 75,347     $ 75,650  
                 
II. Risk-Weighted Assets
               
Market risk
  $ 169,649     $ 176,646  
Credit risk
    172,195       184,055  
Operational risk
    40,000       39,675  
                 
Total Risk-Weighted Assets
  $ 381,844     $ 400,376  
                 
III. Tier 1 Capital Ratio
    16.1 %     15.6 %
IV. Total Capital Ratio
    19.7 %     18.9 %
 
 
(1) Principally includes the cumulative change in the fair value of the firm’s unsecured borrowings attributable to the impact of changes in the firm’s own credit spreads, disallowed deferred tax assets, and investments in certain nonconsolidated entities.
 
(2) Substantially all of the firm’s existing subordinated debt qualifies as Total Allowable Capital.
 
The firm’s RWAs based on the guidelines applicable to the firm when it was regulated as a CSE are driven by the amount of market risk, credit risk and operational risk associated with its business activities in a manner generally consistent with methodologies set out in Basel II. The methodologies used to compute these RWAs for each of market risk, credit risk and operational risk are closely aligned with the firm’s risk management practices.
 
The firm is currently working to implement the Basel II framework as applicable to it as a bank holding company (as opposed to as a CSE). U.S. banking regulators have incorporated the Basel II framework into the existing risk-based capital requirements by requiring that internationally active banking organizations, such as Group Inc., transition to Basel II over the next several years.


69


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
GS Bank USA, a New York State-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System and the FDIC, is regulated by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Banking Department (NYSBD) and is subject to minimum capital requirements that (subject to certain exceptions) are similar to those applicable to bank holding companies. GS Bank USA computes its capital ratios in accordance with the regulatory capital guidelines currently applicable to state member banks, which are based on Basel I as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board, for purposes of assessing the adequacy of its capital. In order to be considered a “well capitalized” depository institution under the Federal Reserve Board guidelines, GS Bank USA must maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 6%, a total capital ratio of at least 10% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 5%. In November 2008, the firm contributed subsidiaries into GS Bank USA. In connection with this contribution, GS Bank USA agreed with the Federal Reserve Board to minimum capital ratios in excess of these “well capitalized” levels. Accordingly, for a period of time, GS Bank USA is expected to maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 8%, a total capital ratio of at least 11% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 6%.
 
The following table sets forth information regarding GS Bank USA’s capital ratios under Basel I as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board, as of June 2009.
 
         
    As of
    June 2009
Tier 1 Capital Ratio
    12.9 %
Total Capital Ratio
    17.2 %
Tier 1 Leverage Ratio
    9.8 %
 
Consistent with the calculation of Group Inc.’s capital ratios, the calculation of GS Bank USA’s capital ratios includes certain market risk measures that are under review by the Federal Reserve Board. Accordingly, these ratios may be revised in subsequent filings. GS Bank USA is currently working to implement the Basel II framework. Similar to the firm’s requirement as a bank holding company, GS Bank USA is required to transition to Basel II over the next several years.
 
The deposits of GS Bank USA are insured by the FDIC to the extent provided by law. The Federal Reserve Board requires depository institutions to maintain cash reserves with a Federal Reserve Bank. The amount deposited by the firm’s depository institution subsidiaries held at the Federal Reserve Bank was approximately $7.04 billion and $94 million as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, which exceeded required reserve amounts by $6.73 billion and $6 million as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. GS Bank Europe, a wholly owned credit institution, is regulated by the Irish Financial Services Regulatory Authority and is subject to minimum capital requirements. As of June 2009 and November 2008, GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe were both in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements.
 
Transactions between GS Bank USA and its subsidiaries and Group Inc. and its subsidiaries and affiliates (other than, generally, subsidiaries of GS Bank USA) are regulated by the Federal Reserve Board. These regulations generally limit the types and amounts of transactions (including loans to and borrowings from GS Bank USA) that may take place and generally require those transactions to be on an arms-length basis.


70


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The firm’s U.S. regulated broker-dealer subsidiaries include GS&Co. and Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P. (GSEC). GS&Co. and GSEC are registered U.S. broker-dealers and futures commission merchants subject to Rule 15c3-1 of the SEC and Rule 1.17 of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, which specify uniform minimum net capital requirements, as defined, for their registrants, and also effectively require that a significant part of the registrants’ assets be kept in relatively liquid form. GS&Co. and GSEC have elected to compute their minimum capital requirements in accordance with the “Alternative Net Capital Requirement” as permitted by Rule 15c3-1. As of June 2009, GS&Co. had regulatory net capital, as defined by Rule 15c3-1, of $13.19 billion, which exceeded the amount required by $11.42 billion. As of June 2009, GSEC had regulatory net capital, as defined by Rule 15c3-1, of $1.87 billion, which exceeded the amount required by $1.80 billion. In addition to its alternative minimum net capital requirements, GS&Co. is also required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of Rule 15c3-1. GS&Co. is also required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. As of June 2009 and November 2008, GS&Co. had tentative net capital and net capital in excess of both the minimum and the notification requirements.
 
The firm has U.S. insurance subsidiaries that are subject to state insurance regulation and oversight in the states in which they are domiciled and in the other states in which they are licensed. In addition, certain of the firm’s insurance subsidiaries outside of the U.S. are regulated by the Bermuda Monetary Authority and by Lloyd’s (which is, in turn, regulated by the U.K.’s Financial Services Authority (FSA)). The firm’s insurance subsidiaries were in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements as of June 2009 and November 2008.
 
The firm’s principal non-U.S. regulated subsidiaries include Goldman Sachs International (GSI) and Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd. (GSJCL). GSI, the firm’s regulated U.K. broker-dealer, is subject to the capital requirements of the FSA. GSJCL, the firm’s regulated Japanese broker-dealer, is subject to the capital requirements imposed by Japan’s Financial Services Agency. As of June 2009 and November 2008, GSI and GSJCL were in compliance with their local capital adequacy requirements. Certain other non-U.S. subsidiaries of the firm are also subject to capital adequacy requirements promulgated by authorities of the countries in which they operate. As of June 2009 and November 2008, these subsidiaries were in compliance with their local capital adequacy requirements.
 
The regulatory requirements referred to above restrict Group Inc.’s ability to withdraw capital from its regulated subsidiaries. In addition to limitations on the payment of dividends imposed by federal and state laws, the Federal Reserve Board, the FDIC and the NYSBD have authority to prohibit or to limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise (including GS Bank USA) if, in the relevant regulator’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in the light of the financial condition of the banking organization. As of June 2009, GS Bank USA could have declared dividends of $1.31 billion to Group Inc. without regulatory approval. As of November 2008, GS Bank USA would not have been able to declare dividends to Group Inc. without regulatory approval.
 
Note 16.   Business Segments
 
In reporting to management, the firm’s operating results are categorized into the following three business segments: Investment Banking, Trading and Principal Investments, and Asset Management and Securities Services. See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of the firm’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 2008 for a discussion of the basis of presentation for the firm’s business segments.


71


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Segment Operating Results
 
Management believes that the following information provides a reasonable representation of each segment’s contribution to consolidated pre-tax earnings and total assets:
 
                                     
        As of or for the
        Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
        June
  May
  June
  May
        2009   2008   2009   2008
        (in millions)
 
Investment
  Net revenues   $ 1,440     $ 1,685     $ 2,263     $ 2,857  
Banking
  Operating expenses     1,167       1,155       1,872       2,095  
                                     
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 273     $ 530     $ 391     $ 762  
                                     
    Segment assets   $ 1,473     $ 7,269     $ 1,473     $ 7,269  
                                     
Trading and
  Net revenues   $ 10,784     $ 5,591     $ 17,934     $ 10,715  
Principal
  Operating expenses     6,290       3,961       11,163       7,704  
                                     
Investments
  Pre-tax earnings   $ 4,494     $ 1,630     $ 6,771     $ 3,011  
                                     
    Segment assets   $ 696,454     $ 724,122     $ 696,454     $ 724,122  
                                     
Asset Management
  Net revenues   $ 1,537     $ 2,146     $ 2,989     $ 4,185  
and Securities
  Operating expenses     1,250       1,477       2,455       2,970  
                                     
Services
  Pre-tax earnings   $ 287     $ 669     $ 534     $ 1,215  
                                     
    Segment assets   $ 191,617     $ 356,754     $ 191,617     $ 356,754  
                                     
Total
  Net revenues (1)(2)   $ 13,761     $ 9,422     $ 23,186     $ 17,757  
    Operating expenses (3)     8,732       6,590       15,528       12,782  
                                     
    Pre-tax earnings (4)   $ 5,029     $ 2,832     $ 7,658     $ 4,975  
                                     
    Total assets   $ 889,544     $ 1,088,145     $ 889,544     $ 1,088,145  
                                     
 
 
(1) Net revenues include net interest income as set forth in the table below:
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
 
Investment Banking
  $     $     $     $ 6  
Trading and Principal Investments
    1,462       352       2,906       599  
Asset Management and Securities Services
    580       925       1,043       1,623  
                                 
Total net interest
  $ 2,042     $ 1,277     $ 3,949     $ 2,228  
                                 
 
(2) Net revenues include non-interest revenues as set forth in the table below:
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
        (in millions)    
 
Investment banking fees
  $ 1,440     $ 1,685     $ 2,263     $ 2,851  
Equities commissions
    1,021       1,234       1,995       2,472  
Asset management and other fees
    957       1,221       1,946       2,562  
Trading and principal investments revenues
    8,301       4,005       13,033       7,644  
                                 
Total non-interest revenues
  $ 11,719     $ 8,145     $ 19,237     $ 15,529  
                                 


72


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
Trading and principal investments revenues include $10 million and $(3) million for the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, and $16 million and $(2) million for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, of realized gains/(losses) on securities held within the firm’s insurance subsidiaries which are accounted for as available-for-sale under SFAS No. 115.
 
(3) Operating expenses include net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings of $25 million and $(3) million for the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, and $38 million and $13 million for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, that have not been allocated to the firm’s segments.
 
(4) Pre-tax earnings include total depreciation and amortization as set forth in the table below:
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
 
Investment Banking
  $ 39     $ 38     $ 76     $ 76  
Trading and Principal Investments
    428       214       951       460  
Asset Management and Securities Services
    60       59       149       118  
                                 
Total depreciation and amortization
  $ 527     $ 311     $ 1,176     $ 654  
                                 
 
Geographic Information
 
Due to the highly integrated nature of international financial markets, the firm manages its businesses based on the profitability of the enterprise as a whole. Since a significant portion of the firm’s activities require cross-border coordination in order to facilitate the needs of the firm’s clients, the methodology for allocating the firm’s profitability to geographic regions is dependent on estimates and management judgment. Specifically, in interim periods, the firm allocates compensation and benefits to geographic regions based upon the firmwide compensation to net revenues ratio. In the fourth quarter when compensation by employee is finalized, compensation and benefits are allocated to the geographic regions based upon total actual compensation during the fiscal year. See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of the firm’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 2008 for a discussion of the method of allocating by geographic region.


73


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
The following table sets forth the total net revenues and pre-tax earnings of the firm and its consolidated subsidiaries by geographic region allocated based on the methodology referred to above, as well as the percentage of total net revenues and pre-tax earnings for each geographic region:
 
                                                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June 2009   May 2008   June 2009   May 2008
    ($ in millions)
Net revenues
                                                               
Americas (1)
  $ 7,019       51 %   $ 5,316       57 %   $ 13,492       58 %   $ 9,523       53 %
EMEA (2)
    3,727       27       2,756       29       5,613       24       5,430       31  
Asia
    3,015       22       1,350       14       4,081       18       2,804       16  
                                                                 
Total net revenues
  $ 13,761       100 %   $ 9,422       100 %   $ 23,186       100 %   $ 17,757       100 %
                                                                 
Pre-tax earnings
                                                               
Americas (1)
  $ 2,385       47 %   $ 1,651       58 %   $ 4,530       59 %   $ 2,650       53 %
EMEA (2)
    1,562       31       865       31       2,141       28       1,652       33  
Asia
    1,107       22       313       11       1,025       13       686       14  
Corporate (3)
    (25 )     N.M.       3       N.M.       (38 )     N.M.       (13 )     N.M.  
                                                                 
Total pre-tax earnings
  $ 5,029       100 %   $ 2,832       100 %   $ 7,658       100 %   $ 4,975       100 %
                                                                 
 
 
(1) Substantially all relates to the U.S.
 
(2) EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa).
 
(3) Consists of net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings.


74


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 17.   Interest Income and Interest Expense
 
The following table sets forth the details of the firm’s interest income and interest expense:
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
Interest income (1)
                               
Deposits with banks
  $ 18     $ 38     $ 40     $ 87  
Securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold
    176       3,184       727       7,314  
Trading assets, at fair value
    2,881       3,426       6,039       7,143  
Other interest (2)
    395       2,850       1,026       6,199  
                                 
Total interest income
  $ 3,470     $ 9,498     $ 7,832     $ 20,743  
                                 
Interest expense
                               
Deposits
  $ 119     $ 186     $ 269     $ 386  
Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
    366       1,875       911       4,486  
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    406       630       869       1,327  
Short-term borrowings (3)
    154       448       394       985  
Long-term borrowings (4)
    648       1,891       1,597       4,260  
Other interest (5)
    (265 )     3,191       (157 )     7,071  
                                 
Total interest expense
  $ 1,428     $ 8,221     $ 3,883     $ 18,515  
                                 
Net interest income
  $ 2,042     $ 1,277     $ 3,949     $ 2,228  
                                 
 
 
(1) Interest income is recorded on an accrual basis based on contractual interest rates.
 
(2) Primarily includes interest income on customer debit balances and other interest-earning assets.
 
(3) Includes interest on unsecured short-term borrowings and short-term other secured financings.
 
(4) Includes interest on unsecured long-term borrowings and long-term other secured financings.
 
(5) Primarily includes interest expense on customer credit balances and other interest-bearing liabilities.
 
Note 18.   Subsequent Event
 
On July 22, 2009, Group Inc. repurchased in full from the U.S. Treasury the warrant to purchase 12.2 million shares of common stock that was issued to the U.S. Treasury pursuant to the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program. The purchase price paid by Group Inc. to the U.S. Treasury for this warrant was $1.1 billion. This amount was recorded as a reduction to shareholders’ equity.


75


Table of Contents

 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
 
To the Board of Directors and the Shareholders of
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.:
 
We have reviewed the accompanying condensed consolidated statement of financial condition of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (the Company) as of June 26, 2009, the related condensed consolidated statements of earnings for the three and six months ended June 26, 2009 and May 30, 2008, the condensed consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity for the six months ended June 26, 2009, the condensed consolidated statements of cash flows for the six months ended June 26, 2009 and May 30, 2008, and the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income for the three and six months ended June 26, 2009 and May 30, 2008. These condensed consolidated interim financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management.
 
We conducted our review in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). A review of interim financial information consists principally of applying analytical procedures and making inquiries of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters. It is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the objective of which is the expression of an opinion regarding the financial statements taken as a whole. Accordingly, we do not express such an opinion.
 
Based on our review, we are not aware of any material modifications that should be made to the accompanying condensed consolidated interim financial statements for them to be in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
 
We previously audited in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated statement of financial condition as of November 28, 2008, and the related consolidated statements of earnings, changes in shareholders’ equity, cash flows and comprehensive income for the year then ended (not presented herein), and in our report dated January 22, 2009, we expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements. In our opinion, the information set forth in the accompanying condensed consolidated statement of financial condition as of November 28, 2008 and the condensed consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity for the year ended November 28, 2008, is fairly stated in all material respects in relation to the consolidated financial statements from which it has been derived.
 
/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers, LLP
 
New York, New York
August 4, 2009


76


Table of Contents

 
STATISTICAL DISCLOSURES
 
Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
 
The following tables set forth a summary of consolidated average balances and interest rates for the three and six months ended June 2009 and May 2008:
 
                                                 
    Three Months Ended
    June 2009   May 2008
            Average
          Average
    Average
      rate
  Average
      rate
   
balance
 
Interest
 
(annualized)
 
balance
 
Interest
 
(annualized)
    (in millions, except rates)
Assets
                                               
Deposits with banks
  $ 25,040     $ 18       0.29 %   $ 5,300     $ 38       2.88 %
U.S. 
    18,220       13       0.29       1,387       2       0.58  
Non-U.S. 
    6,820       5       0.29       3,913       36       3.70  
Securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold
    354,792       176       0.20       445,615       3,184       2.87  
U.S. 
    268,925       (109 )     (0.16 )     354,145       2,194       2.49  
Non-U.S. 
    85,867       285       1.33       91,470       990       4.35  
Trading assets, at fair value (1)(2)
    267,542       2,881       4.32       362,204       3,426       3.80  
U.S. 
    193,117       2,231       4.63       198,807       1,824       3.69  
Non-U.S. 
    74,425       650       3.50       163,397       1,602       3.94  
Other interest-earning assets (3)
    125,783       395       1.26       229,684       2,850       4.99  
U.S. 
    77,381       206       1.07       135,980       1,376       4.07  
Non-U.S. 
    48,402       189       1.57       93,704       1,474       6.33  
                                                 
Total interest-earning assets
    773,157       3,470       1.80       1,042,803       9,498       3.66  
Cash and due from banks
    9,428                       7,275                  
Other noninterest-earning assets (2)
    122,478                       160,248                  
                                                 
Total assets
  $ 905,063                     $ 1,210,326                  
                                                 
Liabilities
                                               
Deposits
  $ 42,571     $ 119       1.12 %   $ 29,282     $ 186       2.55 %
U.S. 
    36,717       107       1.17       23,063       143       2.49  
Non-U.S. 
    5,854       12       0.82       6,219       43       2.78  
Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
    150,602       366       0.97       216,994       1,875       3.48  
U.S. 
    108,002       110       0.41       120,318       905       3.03  
Non-U.S. 
    42,600       256       2.41       96,676       970       4.04  
Trading liabilities, at fair value (1)(2)
    67,262       406       2.42       101,166       630       2.50  
U.S. 
    35,324       86       0.98       50,028       194       1.56  
Non-U.S. 
    31,938       320       4.02       51,138       436       3.43  
Commercial paper
    381             0.26       4,453       24       2.17  
U.S. 
    260             0.22       2,968       16       2.17  
Non-U.S. 
    121             0.36       1,485       8       2.17  
Other borrowings (4)(5)
    60,017       154       1.03       104,537       424       1.63  
U.S. 
    36,250       130       1.44       53,265       216       1.63  
Non-U.S. 
    23,767       24       0.41       51,272       208       1.63  
Long-term borrowings (5)(6)
    205,941       648       1.26       216,612       1,891       3.51  
U.S. 
    194,460       596       1.23       192,750       1,683       3.51  
Non-U.S. 
    11,481       52       1.82       23,862       208       3.51  
Other interest-bearing liabilities (7)
    210,979       (265 )     (0.50 )     365,881       3,191       3.51  
U.S. 
    146,049       (374 )     (1.03 )     222,508       770       1.39  
Non-U.S. 
    64,930       109       0.67       143,373       2,421       6.79  
                                                 
Total interest-bearing liabilities
    737,753       1,428       0.78       1,038,925       8,221       3.18  
Noninterest-bearing deposits
    83                                        
Other noninterest-bearing liabilities (2)
    100,357                       128,140                  
                                                 
Total liabilities
    838,193                       1,167,065                  
Shareholders’ equity
                                               
Preferred stock
    14,125                       3,100                  
Common stock
    52,745                       40,161                  
                                                 
Total shareholders’ equity
    66,870                       43,261                  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 905,063                     $ 1,210,326                  
                                                 
Interest rate spread
                    1.02 %                     0.48 %
Net interest income and net yield on interest-earning assets
          $ 2,042       1.06             $ 1,277       0.49  
U.S.
            1,686       1.21               1,469       0.86  
Non-U.S. 
            356       0.66               (192 )     (0.22 )
Percentage of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities attributable to non-U.S. operations (8)
                                               
Assets
                    27.87 %                     33.80 %
Liabilities
                    24.49                       36.00  


77


Table of Contents

STATISTICAL DISCLOSURES
 
                                                 
    Six Months Ended
    June 2009   May 2008
            Average
          Average
    Average
      rate
  Average
      rate
   
balance
 
Interest
 
(annualized)
 
balance
 
Interest
 
(annualized)
    (in millions, except rates)
Assets
                                               
Deposits with banks
  $ 22,960     $ 40       0.35 %   $ 5,359     $ 87       3.26 %
U.S. 
    18,321       26       0.28       1,403       12       1.72  
Non-U.S. 
    4,639       14       0.61       3,956       75       3.81  
Securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold
    355,035       727       0.41       416,489       7,314       3.53  
U.S. 
    266,682       52       0.04       330,835       5,606       3.41  
Non-U.S. 
    88,353       675       1.53       85,654       1,708       4.01  
Trading assets, at fair value (1)(2)
    281,637       6,039       4.30       372,556       7,143       3.86  
U.S. 
    205,771       4,807       4.69       204,059       4,019       3.96  
Non-U.S. 
    75,866       1,232       3.26       168,497       3,124       3.73  
Other interest-earning assets (3)
    142,857       1,026       1.44       243,218       6,199       5.13  
U.S. 
    93,725       568       1.22       139,951       2,539       3.65  
Non-U.S. 
    49,132       458       1.87       103,267       3,660       7.13  
                                                 
Total interest-earning assets
    802,489       7,832       1.96       1,037,622       20,743       4.02  
Cash and due from banks
    6,344                       7,062                  
Other noninterest-earning assets (2)
    133,510                       148,435                  
                                                 
Total assets
  $ 942,343                     $ 1,193,119                  
                                                 
Liabilities
                                               
Deposits
  $ 41,049     $ 269       1.31 %   $ 25,090     $ 386       3.09 %
U.S. 
    35,493       243       1.37       21,065       332       3.17  
Non-U.S. 
    5,556       26       0.94       4,025       54       2.70  
Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
    168,946       911       1.08       219,811       4,486       4.10  
U.S. 
    122,369       259       0.42       123,344       2,425       3.95  
Non-U.S. 
    46,577       652       2.81       96,467       2,061       4.30  
Trading liabilities, at fair value (1)(2)
    65,273       869       2.67       107,146       1,327       2.49  
U.S. 
    33,166       238       1.44       55,468       448       1.62  
Non-U.S. 
    32,107       631       3.94       51,678       879       3.42  
Commercial paper
    525       3       1.15       6,494       98       3.03  
U.S. 
    322       3       1.87       5,226       83       3.19  
Non-U.S. 
    203             0.19       1,268       15       2.38  
Other borrowings (4) (5)
    67,122       391       1.17       104,240       887       1.71  
U.S. 
    42,701       337       1.58       52,041       638       2.47  
Non-U.S. 
    24,421       54       0.44       52,199       249       0.96  
Long-term borrowings (5) (6)
    203,337       1,597       1.58       207,453       4,260       4.13  
U.S. 
    191,978       1,470       1.54       184,853       3,842       4.18  
Non-U.S. 
    11,359       127       2.24       22,600       418       3.72  
Other interest-bearing liabilities (7)
    218,758       (157 )     (0.14 )     350,275       7,071       4.06  
U.S. 
    152,450       (447 )     (0.59 )     212,636       2,894       2.74  
Non-U.S. 
    66,308       290       0.88       137,639       4,177       6.10  
                                                 
Total interest-bearing liabilities
    765,010       3,883       1.02       1,020,509       18,515       3.65  
Noninterest-bearing deposits
    83                                        
Other noninterest-bearing liabilities (2)
    112,083                       129,534                  
                                                 
Total liabilities
    877,176                       1,150,043                  
Shareholders’ equity
                                               
Preferred stock
    15,139                       3,100                  
Common stock
    50,028                       39,976                  
                                                 
Total shareholders’ equity
    65,167                       43,076                  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 942,343                     $ 1,193,119                  
                                                 
Interest rate spread
                    0.94 %                     0.37 %
Net interest income and net yield on interest-earning assets
          $ 3,949       0.99             $ 2,228       0.43  
U.S. 
            3,350       1.15               1,514       0.45  
Non-U.S. 
            599       0.55               714       0.40  
Percentage of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities attributable to non-U.S. operations (8)
                                               
Assets
                    27.16 %                     34.83 %
Liabilities
                    24.38                       35.85  


78


Table of Contents

STATISTICAL DISCLOSURES
 
 
 
(1)  Consists of cash trading instruments, including equity securities and convertible debentures.
 
(2)  Derivative instruments are included in other noninterest-earning assets and other noninterest-bearing liabilities.
 
(3)  Primarily consists of cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes and receivables from customers and counterparties.
 
(4)  Consists of short-term other secured financings and unsecured short-term borrowings, excluding commercial paper.
 
(5)  Interest rates include the effects of hedging in accordance with SFAS No. 133.
 
(6)  Consists of long-term other secured financings and unsecured long-term borrowings.
 
(7)  Primarily consists of payables to customers and counterparties.
 
(8)  Assets, liabilities and interest are attributed to U.S. and non-U.S. based on the location of the legal entity in which the assets and liabilities are held.


79


Table of Contents

STATISTICAL DISCLOSURES
 
Ratios
 
The following table sets forth selected financial ratios:
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
Annualized net earnings to average assets
    1.5 %     0.7 %     1.1 %     0.6 %
Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity (1)
    23.0  (3)     20.4       18.3  (3)     17.6  
Annualized return on average total shareholders’ equity (2)
    20.5       19.3       16.1       16.7  
Total average equity to average assets
    7.4       3.6       6.9       3.6  
 
 
(1) Based on annualized net earnings applicable to common shareholders divided by average monthly common shareholders’ equity.
 
(2) Based on annualized net earnings divided by average monthly total shareholders’ equity.
 
(3) The one-time preferred dividend of $426 million related to the repurchase of the firm’s TARP preferred stock (calculated as the difference between the carrying value and the redemption value of the preferred stock) in the second quarter of 2009 was not annualized in the calculation of annualized net earnings to common shareholders since it has no impact on other quarters in the year.
 
Cross-border Outstandings
 
Cross-border outstandings are based upon the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s (FFIEC) regulatory guidelines for reporting cross-border risk. Claims include cash, receivables, securities purchased under agreements to resell, securities borrowed and cash trading instruments, but exclude derivative instruments and commitments. Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed are presented based on the domicile of the counterparty, without reduction for related securities collateral held.
 
The following table sets forth cross-border outstandings for each country in which cross-border outstandings exceed 0.75% of consolidated assets as of June 2009 in accordance with the FFIEC guidelines:
 
                                 
   
Banks
 
Governments
 
Other
 
Total
    (in millions)
Country
                               
United Kingdom
  $ 5,757     $ 6,604     $ 40,126     $ 52,487  
Japan
    18,301       230       4,293       22,824  
Germany
    1,893       6,784       12,559       21,236  
Cayman Islands
    36       1       15,147       15,184  
France
    4,103       3,246       4,878       12,227  
Italy
    692       8,002       533       9,227  
China
    7,359       29       1,617       9,005  


80


Table of Contents

Item 2:   Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
INDEX
 
         
    Page
    No.
 
    82  
       
    84  
       
    87  
       
    88  
       
    88  
       
    97  
       
    99  
       
    99  
       
    100  
       
    106  
       
    113  
       
    113  
       
    114  
       
    119  
       
    121  
       
    126  
       
    127  
       
    131  
       
    138  
       
    139  


81


Table of Contents

 
Introduction
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc.) is a leading global financial services firm providing investment banking, securities and investment management services to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments and high-net-worth individuals. Founded in 1869, the firm is headquartered in New York and maintains offices in London, Frankfurt, Tokyo, Hong Kong and other major financial centers around the world.
 
Our activities are divided into three segments:
 
  •  Investment Banking.  We provide a broad range of investment banking services to a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals.
 
  •  Trading and Principal Investments.  We facilitate client transactions with a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals and take proprietary positions through market making in, trading of and investing in fixed income and equity products, currencies, commodities and derivatives on these products. In addition, we engage in market-making and specialist activities on equities and options exchanges, and we clear client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide. In connection with our merchant banking and other investing activities, we make principal investments directly and through funds that we raise and manage.
 
  •  Asset Management and Securities Services.  We provide investment advisory and financial planning services and offer investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and provide prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and to high-net-worth individuals worldwide.
 
This Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations should be read in conjunction with our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008. References herein to our Annual Report on Form 10-K are to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008.
 
When we use the terms “Goldman Sachs,” “we,” “us” and “our,” we mean Group Inc., a Delaware corporation, and its consolidated subsidiaries.
 
In connection with becoming a bank holding company, we were required to change our fiscal year-end from November to December. This change in our fiscal year-end resulted in a one-month transition period that began on November 29, 2008 and ended on December 26, 2008. Financial information for this fiscal transition period is included in our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 27, 2009. On April 13, 2009, the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (the Board) approved a change in our fiscal year-end from the last Friday of December to December 31, beginning with fiscal 2009. Fiscal 2009 began on December 27, 2008 and will end on December 31, 2009. Our third fiscal quarter in 2009 will end on the last Friday of September. Beginning in the fourth quarter of 2009, our fiscal year will end on December 31.
 
In “Results of Operations” below, we compare the three and six month periods, as applicable, ended June 26, 2009 with the previously reported three and six month periods ended May 30, 2008. Financial information for the three and six months ended June 27, 2008 has not been included in this Form 10-Q for the following reasons: (i) the three and six months ended May 30, 2008 provide a meaningful comparison for the three and six months ended June 26, 2009; (ii) there are no significant factors, seasonal or other, that would impact the comparability of information if the results for the three and six months ended June 27, 2008 were presented in lieu of results for the three and six months ended May 30, 2008; and (iii) it was not practicable or cost justified to prepare this information.


82


Table of Contents

All references to June 2009 and May 2008, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to our three-month fiscal periods ended, or the dates, as the context requires, June 26, 2009 and May 30, 2008, respectively. All references to November 2008, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to our fiscal year ended, or the date, as the context requires, November 28, 2008. All references to 2009, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to our fiscal year ending, or the date, as the context requires, December 31, 2009.


83


Table of Contents

 
Executive Overview
 
Three Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Our diluted earnings per common share were $4.93 for the second quarter ended June 26, 2009 compared with $4.58 for the second quarter ended May 30, 2008. Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity (ROE) (1) was 23.0% for the second quarter of 2009. During the quarter, the firm repurchased the preferred stock that was issued to the U.S. Department of the Treasury (U.S. Treasury) pursuant to its TARP Capital Purchase Program for an aggregate purchase price of $10.04 billion (including accrued dividends). The repurchase resulted in a one-time preferred dividend of $426 million, which is included in our results for the second quarter of 2009. Excluding this one-time preferred dividend, diluted earnings per common share were $5.71 (2) and annualized ROE was 23.8% (2) for the second quarter of 2009. In addition, the firm completed a public offering of common stock for proceeds of $5.75 billion. During the quarter, book value per common share increased approximately 8% to $106.41 and tangible book value per common share (3) increased approximately 10% to $96.94. Our Tier 1 capital ratio under Basel I (4) was 13.8% at the end of the second quarter of 2009, up from 13.7% at the end of the first quarter of 2009. Our Tier 1 capital ratio under Basel II (4) was 16.1% at the end of the second quarter of 2009, up from 16.0% at the end of the first quarter of 2009.
 
Our results for the second quarter of 2009 reflected significantly higher net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments compared with the second quarter of 2008, partially offset by significantly lower net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services and lower net revenues in Investment Banking. The increase in Trading and Principal Investments reflected particularly strong results in Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities (FICC) and Equities, which were both significantly higher than the second quarter of 2008. The increase in FICC reflected particularly strong performances in credit products, interest rate products and currencies, reflecting strength in the client franchise. In addition, net revenues in both mortgages and commodities were higher compared with the second quarter of 2008. In the second quarter of 2009, mortgages included a loss of approximately $700 million on commercial mortgage loans. During the quarter, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, particularly in more liquid products, favorable market opportunities and tighter corporate credit spreads. The increase in Equities reflected significantly higher net revenues in derivatives and, to a lesser extent, principal strategies. In addition, net revenues in shares were solid, but essentially unchanged compared with the second quarter of 2008. Commissions declined compared with the second quarter of 2008. During the quarter, Equities operated in an environment characterized by solid client-driven activity, favorable market opportunities, a significant increase in global equity prices and a decline in volatility levels. Results in Principal Investments were also higher compared with the second quarter of 2008, and included a gain of $948 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of Industrial and Commercial Bank of China Limited (ICBC), a gain of $343 million from corporate principal investments and a loss of $499 million from real estate principal investments.
 
The decline in Asset Management and Securities Services reflected significantly lower net revenues in both Asset Management and Securities Services compared with the second quarter of 2008. The decrease in Securities Services primarily reflected the impact of lower customer balances compared with the second quarter of 2008. The decrease in Asset Management principally reflected the impact of lower assets under management, due to market depreciation since the end of the second quarter of 2008. During the quarter, assets under management increased $48 billion to $819 billion, due to $42 billion of market appreciation, primarily in equity and fixed income assets, and $6 billion of net inflows.


84


Table of Contents

The decline in Investment Banking reflected significantly lower net revenues in Financial Advisory, partially offset by significantly higher net revenues in Underwriting compared with the second quarter of 2008. The decrease in Financial Advisory reflected a significant decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. The increase in Underwriting reflected significantly higher net revenues in equity underwriting, which achieved its highest quarterly performance, as well as higher net revenues in debt underwriting. The increase in equity underwriting reflected very strong client activity. The increase in debt underwriting primarily reflected higher net revenues from investment-grade and municipal activity. Our investment banking transaction backlog decreased during the quarter. (5)
 
Six Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Our diluted earnings per common share were $8.42 for the six months ended June 26, 2009 compared with $7.81 for the six months ended May 30, 2008. Annualized ROE (1) was 18.3% for the first half of 2009. Excluding the one-time preferred dividend of $426 million related to the repurchase of our TARP preferred stock, diluted earnings per common share were $9.23 (2) and annualized ROE was 19.2% (2) for the first half of 2009.
 
Our results for the first half of 2009 reflected significantly higher net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments, partially offset by significantly lower net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services, and Investment Banking. The increase in Trading and Principal Investments reflected significantly higher net revenues in FICC, which were more than double the amount in the first half of 2008, as well as higher net revenues in Equities, partially offset by weak results in Principal Investments. The increase in FICC reflected particularly strong results in credit products, interest rate products and, to a lesser extent, commodities, reflecting strength in the client franchise. In addition, results in mortgages were significantly higher compared with a difficult first half of 2008, while net revenues in currencies were solid, but lower compared with the first half of 2008. In the first half of 2009, mortgages included a loss of approximately $1.5 billion on commercial mortgage loans. During the first half of 2009, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, particularly in more liquid products, and favorable market opportunities. The increase in Equities reflected particularly strong net revenues in derivatives, as well as higher results in principal strategies. These increases were partially offset by lower net revenues in shares compared with the first half of 2008. Commissions declined compared with the first half of 2008. During the first half of 2009, Equities operated in an environment generally characterized by an increase in global equity prices (principally during our second quarter) and high, but declining, levels of volatility. In the first half of 2009, results in Principal Investments reflected net losses of $1.14 billion from real estate principal investments and $278 million from corporate principal investments, partially offset by a gain of $797 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC.
 
The decline in Asset Management and Securities Services reflected significant decreases in both Asset Management and Securities Services. The decrease in Asset Management primarily reflected the impact of lower assets under management, due to market depreciation during the second half of 2008. The decrease in Securities Services primarily reflected the impact of lower customer balances.
 
The decline in Investment Banking primarily reflected significantly lower net revenues in Financial Advisory, due to a significant decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. Net revenues in Underwriting were slightly lower compared with the first half of 2008, primarily due to lower net revenues in debt underwriting, reflecting a decrease in leveraged finance activity. Net revenues in equity underwriting were essentially unchanged compared with the first half of 2008.
 
Our business, by its nature, does not produce predictable earnings. Our results in any given period can be materially affected by conditions in global financial markets and economic conditions generally. For a further discussion of the factors that may affect our future operating results, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.


85


Table of Contents

 
(1)  Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity (ROE) is computed by dividing annualized net earnings applicable to common shareholders by average monthly common shareholders’ equity. The one-time preferred dividend of $426 million related to the repurchase of our TARP preferred stock (calculated as the difference between the carrying value and the redemption value of the preferred stock) was not annualized in the calculation of annualized net earnings applicable to common shareholders since it has no impact on other quarters in the year. See “— Results of Operations — Financial Overview” below for further information regarding our calculation of ROE.
 
(2)  We believe that presenting our results excluding the impact of the one-time preferred dividend of $426 million related to the repurchase of our TARP preferred stock is meaningful because it increases the comparability of period-to-period results. See “— Results of Operations — Financial Overview” below for further information regarding our calculation of diluted earnings per common share and ROE excluding the impact of this one-time dividend.
 
(3)  Tangible common shareholders’ equity equals total shareholders’ equity less preferred stock, goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. Tangible book value per common share is computed by dividing tangible common shareholders’ equity by the number of common shares outstanding, including restricted stock units granted to employees with no future service requirements. We believe that tangible common shareholders’ equity is meaningful because it is one of the measures that we and investors use to assess capital adequacy. See “— Equity Capital — Capital Ratios and Metrics” below for further information regarding tangible common shareholders’ equity.
 
(4)  As a bank holding company, we are subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve Board. We are reporting our Tier 1 capital ratio calculated in accordance with the regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies, which are based on the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel I). The calculation of our Tier 1 capital ratio under Basel I includes certain market risk measures that are under review by the Federal Reserve Board, as part of our transition to bank holding company status. The calculation of our Tier 1 capital ratio has not been reviewed with the Federal Reserve Board and, accordingly, may be revised in subsequent filings. We also continue to disclose our Tier 1 capital ratio calculated in accordance with the capital guidelines applicable to us when we were regulated by the SEC as a Consolidated Supervised Entity (CSE). These guidelines were generally consistent with those set out in the Revised Framework for the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel II). See “— Equity Capital” below for a further discussion of our capital ratios.
 
(5)  Our investment banking transaction backlog represents an estimate of our future net revenues from investment banking transactions where we believe that future revenue realization is more likely than not.


86


Table of Contents

 
Business Environment
 
Global economic conditions remained weak, but showed some signs of stabilization during our second quarter of fiscal 2009. Although real gross domestic product (GDP) continued to decline in most major economies, the decline was significantly less than in the first quarter of fiscal 2009, and economic activity in a number of emerging economies improved. Global equity markets increased significantly during our second quarter, and volatility levels generally declined. In addition, corporate credit spreads tightened during our second quarter. The price of crude oil increased, but remained well below the levels reached in fiscal 2008. The U.S. dollar depreciated against the British pound, the Euro and the Japanese yen. In investment banking, industry-wide mergers and acquisitions activity remained weak, while industry-wide equity and equity-related offerings increased significantly during our second quarter, particularly in the financial sector.
 
In the U.S., real GDP continued to decline during our second quarter, although at a slower pace compared with our first quarter. Residential investment continued to contract due to ongoing weakness in the housing market and the rate of unemployment continued to rise at a rapid pace. However, the fiscal stimulus package contributed to an increase in government expenditure. The rate of inflation declined during our second quarter, reflecting rising excess production capacity. The U.S. Federal Reserve maintained its federal funds rate at a target range of zero to 0.25% during our second quarter. The 10-year U.S. Treasury note yield ended our second quarter 74 basis points higher at 3.52%. In equity markets, the NASDAQ Composite Index, the S&P 500 Index and the Dow Jones Industrial Average increased by 19%, 13% and 9%, respectively, during our second quarter.
 
In the Eurozone economies, real GDP declined during our second quarter, as business investment, exports and consumer spending remained weak. Labor markets also remained weak, with the rate of unemployment rising in the major economies. However, surveys of business and consumer confidence recovered from the very low levels during our first quarter. In response to a continued challenging economic outlook and declining inflation, the European Central Bank further lowered its main refinancing operations rate by 50 basis points to 1.00%. The Euro appreciated by 6% against the U.S. dollar. In the U.K., real GDP appeared to decline during the quarter, due to weaker consumer and business investment spending, partially offset by stronger exports. The Bank of England maintained its official bank rate at 0.50% during the quarter. After a period of sustained weakness over the previous two quarters, the British pound appreciated by 15% against the U.S. dollar. Equity markets in both the U.K. and continental Europe increased significantly during our second quarter, while long-term government bond yields increased.
 
In Japan, real GDP appeared to increase during our second quarter, after a significant decline in the first quarter. A recovery in exports and consumer spending more than offset continued weakness in business investment. Business confidence improved slightly but remained at low levels and the rate of unemployment continued to rise. Measures of inflation declined during the quarter. The Bank of Japan left its target overnight call rate unchanged at 0.10%, while the yield on 10-year Japanese government bonds increased slightly during the quarter. The Japanese yen appreciated by 3% against the U.S. dollar and the Nikkei 225 Index increased 14% during our second quarter.
 
In China, real GDP growth accelerated during our second quarter as strong domestic demand, led by high levels of consumption and fixed investment spending, helped to offset weak export demand. Measures of inflation continued to decline during the quarter. The People’s Bank of China left its one-year benchmark lending rate unchanged at 5.31%. The Chinese yuan remained essentially unchanged against the U.S. dollar and the Shanghai Composite Index increased 23% during our second quarter. Equity markets in Hong Kong and Korea also ended the quarter significantly higher. In India, the pace of economic growth also accelerated due to an increase in business investment and consumer spending. The Indian rupee appreciated by 5% against the U.S. dollar during our second quarter and equity markets in India ended the quarter significantly higher.


87


Table of Contents

 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
Fair Value
 
The use of fair value to measure financial instruments, with related unrealized gains or losses generally recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in our condensed consolidated statements of earnings, is fundamental to our financial statements and our risk management processes and is our most critical accounting policy. The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e., the exit price) in accordance with SFAS No. 157, “Fair Value Measurements.” Financial assets are marked to bid prices and financial liabilities are marked to offer prices.
 
In October 2008, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) No. FAS 157-3, “Determining the Fair Value of a Financial Asset When the Market for That Asset Is Not Active,” which specifies that it is acceptable to use inputs based on management estimates or assumptions, or for management to make adjustments to observable inputs, to determine fair value when markets are not active and relevant observable inputs are not available. In April 2009, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 157-4, “Determining Fair Value When the Volume and Level of Activity for the Asset or Liability Have Significantly Decreased and Identifying Transactions That Are Not Orderly,” which provides additional guidance for estimating fair value when the volume and level of activity for an asset or liability have decreased significantly. Our fair value measurement policies are consistent with the guidance in both FSP No. FAS 157-3 and FSP No. FAS 157-4. See Note 2 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding FSP No. FAS 157-4.
 
Substantially all trading assets and trading liabilities are reflected in our condensed consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value, pursuant principally to:
 
  •  SFAS No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities;”
 
  •  specialized industry accounting for broker-dealers and investment companies;
 
  •  SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities;” or
 
  •  the fair value option under either SFAS No. 155, “Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments — an amendment of FASB Statements No. 133 and 140,” or SFAS No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities,” (i.e., the fair value option).


88


Table of Contents

 
In determining fair value, we separate our “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” into two categories: cash instruments and derivative contracts, as set forth in the following table:
 
Trading Instruments by Category
(in millions)
 
                                 
    As of June 2009   As of November 2008
    Trading
  Trading
  Trading
  Trading
    Assets, at
  Liabilities, at
  Assets, at
  Liabilities, at
   
Fair Value
 
Fair Value
 
Fair Value
 
Fair Value
Cash trading instruments
  $ 244,617     $ 77,819     $ 186,231     $ 57,143  
ICBC
    6,269  (1)           5,496  (1)      
SMFG
    1,330       1,327  (4)     1,135       1,134  (4)
Other principal investments
    13,009  (2)           15,126  (2)      
                                 
Principal investments
    20,608       1,327       21,757       1,134  
                                 
Cash instruments
    265,225       79,146       207,988       58,277  
Exchange-traded
    4,709       5,573       6,164       8,347  
Over-the-counter
    85,317       62,578       124,173       109,348  
                                 
Derivative contracts
    90,026  (3)     68,151  (5)     130,337  (3)     117,695  (5)
                                 
Total
  $ 355,251     $ 147,297     $ 338,325     $ 175,972  
                                 
 
 
(1) Includes interests of $3.96 billion and $3.48 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs. The fair value of our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, which trade on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong, includes the effect of foreign exchange revaluation for which we maintain an economic currency hedge.
 
(2) The following table sets forth the principal investments (in addition to our investments in ICBC and Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. (SMFG)) included within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment:
 
                                                 
    As of June 2009   As of November 2008
   
Corporate
 
Real Estate
 
Total
 
Corporate
 
Real Estate
 
Total
    (in millions)
 
Private
  $ 9,407     $ 1,812     $ 11,219     $ 10,726     $ 2,935     $ 13,661  
Public
    1,747       43       1,790       1,436       29       1,465  
                                                 
Total
  $ 11,154     $ 1,855     $ 13,009     $ 12,162     $ 2,964     $ 15,126  
                                                 
 
(3) Net of cash received pursuant to credit support agreements of $133.34 billion and $137.16 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(4) Represents an economic hedge on the shares of common stock underlying our investment in the convertible preferred stock of SMFG.
 
(5) Net of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements of $16.31 billion and $34.01 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.


89


Table of Contents

Cash Instruments.  Cash instruments include cash trading instruments, public principal investments and private principal investments.
 
  •  Cash Trading Instruments.  Our cash trading instruments are generally valued using quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. The types of instruments valued based on quoted market prices in active markets include most government obligations, active listed equities and certain money market securities.
 
The types of instruments that trade in markets that are not considered to be active, but are valued based on quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency include most government agency securities, investment-grade corporate bonds, certain mortgage products, certain bank loans and bridge loans, less liquid listed equities, certain state, municipal and provincial obligations and certain money market securities and loan commitments.
 
Certain cash trading instruments trade infrequently and therefore have little or no price transparency. Such instruments include private equity and real estate fund investments, certain bank loans and bridge loans (including certain mezzanine financing, leveraged loans arising from capital market transactions and other corporate bank debt), less liquid corporate debt securities and other debt obligations (including less liquid high-yield corporate bonds, distressed debt instruments and collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) backed by corporate obligations), less liquid mortgage whole loans and securities (backed by either commercial or residential real estate), and acquired portfolios of distressed loans. The transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. This valuation is adjusted only when changes to inputs and assumptions are corroborated by evidence such as transactions in similar instruments, completed or pending third-party transactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.
 
For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidity and/or non-transferability. Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
  •  Public Principal Investments.  Our public principal investments held within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment tend to be large, concentrated holdings resulting from initial public offerings or other corporate transactions, and are valued based on quoted market prices. For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidity and/or non-transferability. Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Our most significant public principal investment is our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC. Our investment in ICBC is valued using the quoted market price adjusted for transfer restrictions. During the quarter ended March 2009, we committed to supplemental transfer restrictions in relation to our investment in ICBC. Under the original transfer restrictions, the ICBC shares we held would have become free from transfer restrictions in equal installments on April 28, 2009 and October 20, 2009. Under the new supplemental transfer restrictions, on April 28, 2009, 20% of the ICBC shares that we held became free from transfer restrictions and we completed the disposition of these shares during the second quarter of 2009. Our remaining ICBC shares are subject to transfer restrictions, which prohibit liquidation at any time prior to April 28, 2010.


90


Table of Contents

We also have an investment in the convertible preferred stock of SMFG. This investment is valued using a model that is principally based on SMFG’s common stock price. During 2008, we converted one-third of our SMFG preferred stock investment into SMFG common stock, and delivered the common stock to close out one-third of our hedge position. As of June 2009, we remained hedged on the common stock underlying our remaining investment in SMFG.
 
  •  Private Principal Investments.  Our private principal investments held within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment include investments in private equity, debt and real estate, primarily held through investment funds. By their nature, these investments have little or no price transparency. We value such instruments initially at transaction price and adjust valuations when evidence is available to support such adjustments. Such evidence includes transactions in similar instruments, completed or pending third-party transactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.
 
Derivative Contracts.  Derivative contracts can be exchange-traded or over-the-counter (OTC). We generally value exchange-traded derivatives using models which calibrate to market-clearing levels and eliminate timing differences between the closing price of the exchange-traded derivatives and their underlying instruments.
 
OTC derivatives are valued using market transactions and other market evidence whenever possible, including market-based inputs to models, model calibration to market-clearing transactions, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Where models are used, the selection of a particular model to value an OTC derivative depends upon the contractual terms of, and specific risks inherent in, the instrument, as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. We generally use similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, credit curves, measures of volatility, prepayment rates and correlations of such inputs. For OTC derivatives that trade in liquid markets, such as generic forwards, swaps and options, model inputs can generally be verified and model selection does not involve significant management judgment.
 
Certain OTC derivatives trade in less liquid markets with limited pricing information, and the determination of fair value for these derivatives is inherently more difficult. Where we do not have corroborating market evidence to support significant model inputs and cannot verify the model to market transactions, the transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. Subsequent to initial recognition, we only update valuation inputs when corroborated by evidence such as similar market transactions, third-party pricing services and/or broker or dealer quotations, or other empirical market data. In circumstances where we cannot verify the model value to market transactions, it is possible that a different valuation model could produce a materially different estimate of fair value. See “— Derivatives” below for further information on our OTC derivatives.
 
When appropriate, valuations are adjusted for various factors such as liquidity, bid/offer spreads and credit considerations. Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Controls Over Valuation of Financial Instruments.  A control infrastructure, independent of the trading and investing functions, is fundamental to ensuring that our financial instruments are appropriately valued at market-clearing levels (i.e., exit prices) and that fair value measurements are reliable and consistently determined.


91


Table of Contents

We employ an oversight structure that includes appropriate segregation of duties. Senior management, independent of the trading and investing functions, is responsible for the oversight of control and valuation policies and for reporting the results of these policies to our Audit Committee. We seek to maintain the necessary resources to ensure that control functions are performed appropriately. We employ procedures for the approval of new transaction types and markets, price verification, review of daily profit and loss, and review of valuation models by personnel with appropriate technical knowledge of relevant products and markets. These procedures are performed by personnel independent of the trading and investing functions. For financial instruments where prices or valuations that require inputs are less observable, we employ, where possible, procedures that include comparisons with similar observable positions, analysis of actual to projected cash flows, comparisons with subsequent sales, reviews of valuations used for collateral management purposes and discussions with senior business leaders. See “— Market Risk” and “— Credit Risk” below for a further discussion of how we manage the risks inherent in our trading and principal investing businesses.
 
Fair Value Hierarchy — Level 3.  SFAS No. 157 establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The objective of a fair value measurement is to determine the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e., the exit price). The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (level 3 measurements). Assets and liabilities are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.
 
Instruments that trade infrequently and therefore have little or no price transparency are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. We determine which instruments are classified within level 3 based on the results of our price verification process. This process is performed by personnel independent of our trading and investing functions who corroborate valuations to external market data (e.g., quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, third-party pricing vendors, recent trading activity and comparative analyses to similar instruments). Instruments with valuations which cannot be corroborated to external market data are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
When broker or dealer quotations or third-party pricing vendors are used for valuation or price verification, greater priority is given to executable quotes. As part of our price verification process, valuations based on quotes are corroborated by comparison both to other quotes and to recent trading activity in the same or similar instruments. The number of quotes obtained varies by instrument and depends on the liquidity of the particular instrument. See Notes 2 and 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding SFAS No. 157.
 
Management’s judgment is required to determine the appropriate risk-adjusted discount rate for cash trading instruments that are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy and that have little or no price transparency as a result of decreased volumes and lower levels of trading activity. In such situations, our valuation is adjusted to approximate rates which market participants would likely consider appropriate for relevant credit and liquidity risks.


92


Table of Contents

Valuation Methodologies for Level 3 Assets.  Instruments classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are initially valued at transaction price, which is considered to be the best initial estimate of fair value. As time passes, transaction price becomes less reliable as an estimate of fair value and accordingly, we use other methodologies to determine fair value, which vary based on the type of instrument, as described below. Regardless of the methodology, valuation inputs and assumptions are only changed when corroborated by substantive evidence. Senior management in control functions, independent of the trading and investing functions, reviews all significant unrealized gains/losses, including the primary drivers of the change in value. Valuations are further corroborated by values realized upon sales of our level 3 assets. An overview of methodologies used to value our level 3 assets subsequent to the transaction date is as follows:
 
  •  Private equity and real estate fund investments.  Investments are generally held at cost for the first year. Recent third-party investments or pending transactions are considered to be the best evidence for any change in fair value. In the absence of such evidence, valuations are based on third-party independent appraisals, transactions in similar instruments, discounted cash flow techniques, valuation multiples and public comparables. Such evidence includes pending reorganizations (e.g., merger proposals, tender offers or debt restructurings); and significant changes in financial metrics (e.g., operating results as compared to previous projections, industry multiples, credit ratings and balance sheet ratios).
 
  •  Bank loans and bridge loans and Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations. Valuations are generally based on discounted cash flow techniques, for which the key inputs are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, market yields for such instruments and recovery assumptions. Inputs are generally determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons both to credit default swaps that reference the same underlying credit risk and to other debt instruments for the same issuer for which observable prices or broker quotes are available.
 
  •  Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate.  Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate are collateralized by specific assets and are generally tranched into varying levels of subordination. Due to the nature of these instruments, valuation techniques vary by instrument. Methodologies include relative value analyses across different tranches, comparisons to transactions in both the underlying collateral and instruments with the same or substantially the same underlying collateral, market indices (such as the CMBX (1)), and credit default swaps, as well as discounted cash flow techniques.
 
  •  Loans and securities backed by residential real estate.  Valuations are based on both proprietary and industry recognized models (including Intex and Bloomberg), discounted cash flow techniques and hypothetical securitization analyses. In the recent market environment, the most significant inputs to the valuation of these instruments are rates of delinquency, default and loss expectations, which are driven in part by housing prices. Inputs are determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons to instruments with similar collateral and risk profiles, including relevant indices such as the ABX (1).
 
  •  Loan portfolios.  Valuations are based on discounted cash flow techniques, for which the key inputs are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows and market yields for such instruments. Inputs are determined based on relative value analyses which incorporate comparisons to recent auction data for other similar loan portfolios.
 
  •  Derivative contracts.  Valuation models are calibrated to initial transaction price. Subsequent changes in valuations are based on observable inputs to the valuation models (e.g., interest rates, credit spreads, volatilities, etc.). Inputs are changed only when corroborated by market data. Valuations of less liquid OTC derivatives are typically based on level 1 or level 2 inputs that can be observed in the market, as well as unobservable inputs, such as correlations and volatilities.
 
 
(1) The CMBX and ABX are indices that track the performance of commercial mortgage bonds and subprime residential mortgage bonds, respectively.


93


Table of Contents

 
Total level 3 assets were $54.44 billion, $59.06 billion and $66.19 billion as of June 2009, March 2009 and November 2008, respectively. The decrease in level 3 assets during the three months ended June 2009 primarily reflected unrealized losses (principally on real estate fund investments, and loans and securities backed by commercial real estate) and sales and paydowns (principally on bank loans and bridge loans and other debt obligations). The decrease in level 3 assets as of June 2009 as compared with November 2008 primarily reflected unrealized losses, principally on private equity and real estate fund investments, loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, and bank loans and bridge loans.
 
The following table sets forth the fair values of financial assets classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy:
 
Level 3 Financial Assets at Fair Value
(in millions)
 
                         
    As of
    June
  March
  November
Description
  2009   2009   2008
Private equity and real estate fund investments (1)
  $ 12,679     $ 13,620     $ 16,006  
Bank loans and bridge loans (2)
    9,669       9,866       11,957  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations (3)
    6,605       7,554       7,596  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities:
                       
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
    6,839       7,705       9,340  
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
    1,862       2,088       2,049  
Loan portfolios (4)
    1,774       1,851       4,118  
                         
Cash instruments
    39,428       42,684       51,066  
Derivative contracts
    15,016       16,378       15,124  
                         
Total level 3 assets at fair value
    54,444       59,062       66,190  
Level 3 assets for which we do not bear economic exposure (5)
    (4,061 )     (4,402 )     (6,616 )
                         
Level 3 assets for which we bear economic exposure
  $ 50,383     $ 54,660     $ 59,574  
                         
 
 
(1) Includes $1.55 billion, $1.82 billion and $2.62 billion as of June 2009, March 2009 and November 2008, respectively, of real estate fund investments.
 
(2) Includes certain mezzanine financing, leveraged loans arising from capital market transactions and other corporate bank debt.
 
(3) Includes $518 million, $739 million and $804 million as of June 2009, March 2009 and November 2008, respectively, of CDOs backed by corporate obligations.
 
(4) Consists of acquired portfolios of distressed loans, primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral.
 
(5) We do not bear economic exposure to these level 3 assets as they are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.


94


Table of Contents

Loans and securities backed by residential real estate.  We securitize, underwrite and make markets in various types of residential mortgages, including prime, Alt-A and subprime. At any point in time, we may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage our long or short risk position in residential real estate. The following table sets forth the fair value of our long positions in prime, Alt-A and subprime mortgage cash instruments:
 
Long Positions in Loans and Securities Backed by Residential Real Estate
(in millions)
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
Prime (1)
  $ 1,511     $ 1,494  
Alt-A
    825       1,845  
Subprime (2)
    1,611       1,906  
                 
Total (3)
  $ 3,947     $ 5,245  
                 
 
 
(1) Excludes U.S. government agency-issued collateralized mortgage obligations of $7.45 billion and $4.27 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively. Also excludes U.S. government agency-issued mortgage pass-through certificates.
 
(2) Includes $209 million and $228 million of CDOs backed by subprime mortgages as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(3) Includes $1.86 billion and $2.05 billion of financial instruments (primarily loans and investment-grade securities, the majority of which were issued during 2006 and 2007) classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
 
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate.  We originate, securitize and syndicate fixed and floating rate commercial mortgages globally. At any point in time, we may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage our risk position in the commercial mortgage market. The following table sets forth the fair value of our long positions in loans and securities backed by commercial real estate by geographic region. The decrease in loans and securities backed by commercial real estate from November 2008 to June 2009 was primarily due to writedowns.
 
Long Positions in Loans and Securities Backed by
Commercial Real Estate by Geographic Region
(in millions)
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
Americas (1)
  $ 6,132     $ 7,433  
EMEA (2)
    1,800       3,304  
Asia
    77       157  
                 
Total (3)
  $ 8,009  (4)   $ 10,894  (5)
                 
 
 
(1) Substantially all relates to the U.S.
 
(2) EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa).
 
(3) Includes $6.84 billion and $9.34 billion of financial instruments classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(4) Comprised of loans of $6.43 billion and commercial mortgage-backed securities of $1.58 billion as of June 2009, of which $7.39 billion was floating rate and $621 million was fixed rate.
 
(5) Comprised of loans of $9.23 billion and commercial mortgage-backed securities of $1.66 billion as of November 2008, of which $9.78 billion was floating rate and $1.11 billion was fixed rate.


95


Table of Contents

Leveraged Lending Capital Market Transactions
 
We arrange, extend and syndicate loans and commitments related to leveraged lending capital market transactions globally. The following table sets forth the notional amount of our leveraged lending capital market transactions by geographic region:
 
Leveraged Lending Capital Market Transactions by Geographic Region
(in millions)
 
                                                 
    As of June 2009   As of November 2008
   
Funded
 
Unfunded
 
Total
 
Funded
 
Unfunded
 
Total
Americas (1)
  $ 1,692     $ 1,204     $ 2,896     $ 3,036     $ 1,735     $ 4,771  
EMEA (2)
    1,765       63       1,828       2,294       259       2,553  
Asia
    612       40       652       568       73       641  
                                                 
Total
  $ 4,069     $ 1,307     $ 5,376  (3)   $ 5,898     $ 2,067     $ 7,965  (3)
                                                 
 
 
(1) Substantially all relates to the U.S.
 
(2) EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa).
 
(3) Represents the notional amount. We account for these transactions at fair value and our exposure was $2.75 billion and $5.53 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
 
Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value.  In addition to “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value,” we have elected to account for certain of our other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value under the fair value option. The primary reasons for electing the fair value option are to reflect economic events in earnings on a timely basis, to mitigate volatility in earnings from using different measurement attributes and to address simplification and cost-benefit considerations.
 
Such financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value include:
 
  •  certain unsecured short-term borrowings, consisting of all promissory notes and commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  •  certain other secured financings, primarily transfers accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140, debt raised through our William Street program and certain other nonrecourse financings;
 
  •  certain unsecured long-term borrowings, including prepaid physical commodity transactions and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  •  resale and repurchase agreements;
 
  •  securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, consisting of our matched book and certain firm financing activities;
 
  •  certain deposits issued by GS Bank USA, as well as securities held by GS Bank USA;
 
  •  certain receivables from customers and counterparties, including certain margin loans, transfers accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases under SFAS No. 140 and prepaid variable share forwards;
 
  •  certain insurance and reinsurance contracts and certain guarantees; and
 
  •  in general, investments acquired after the adoption of SFAS No. 159 where we have significant influence over the investee and would otherwise apply the equity method of accounting. In certain cases, we may apply the equity method of accounting to new investments that are strategic in nature or closely related to our principal business activities, where we have a significant degree of involvement in the cash flows or operations of the investee, or where cost-benefit considerations are less significant.


96


Table of Contents

 
Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
As a result of our acquisitions, principally SLK LLC (SLK) in 2000, The Ayco Company, L.P. (Ayco) in 2003 and our variable annuity and life insurance business in 2006, we have acquired goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. Goodwill is the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of net assets, including identifiable intangible assets, at the acquisition date.
 
Goodwill.  We test the goodwill in each of our operating segments, which are components one level below our three business segments, for impairment at least annually in accordance with SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets,” by comparing the estimated fair value of each operating segment with its estimated net book value. We derive the fair value of each of our operating segments based on valuation techniques we believe market participants would use for each segment (observable average price-to-earnings multiples of our competitors in these businesses and price-to-book multiples). We derive the net book value of our operating segments by estimating the amount of shareholders’ equity required to support the activities of each operating segment. Our last annual impairment test was performed during our 2008 fourth quarter and no impairment was identified.
 
During 2008 (particularly during the fourth quarter) and early 2009, the financial services industry and the securities markets generally were materially and adversely affected by significant declines in the values of nearly all asset classes and by a serious lack of liquidity. If there is a prolonged period of weakness in the business environment and financial markets, our businesses may be adversely affected, which could result in an impairment of goodwill in the future.
 
The following table sets forth the carrying value of our goodwill by operating segment:
 
Goodwill by Operating Segment
(in millions)
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
Investment Banking
               
Underwriting
  $ 125     $ 125  
Trading and Principal Investments
               
FICC
    256       247  
Equities (1)
    2,389       2,389  
Principal Investments
    84       80  
Asset Management and Securities Services
               
Asset Management (2)
    565       565  
Securities Services
    117       117  
                 
Total
  $ 3,536     $ 3,523  
                 
 
 
(1) Primarily related to SLK.
 
(2) Primarily related to Ayco.


97


Table of Contents

Identifiable Intangible Assets.  We amortize our identifiable intangible assets over their estimated lives in accordance with SFAS No. 142 or, in the case of insurance contracts, in accordance with SFAS No. 60, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises,” and SFAS No. 97, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for Certain Long-Duration Contracts and for Realized Gains and Losses from the Sale of Investments.” Identifiable intangible assets are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable in accordance with SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets,” or SFAS No. 60 and SFAS No. 97. An impairment loss, generally calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.
 
The following table sets forth the carrying value and range of remaining lives of our identifiable intangible assets by major asset class:
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets by Asset Class
($ in millions)
 
                         
    As of June 2009   As of November 2008
        Range of Estimated
   
    Carrying
  Remaining Lives
  Carrying
   
Value
 
(in years)
 
Value
Customer lists (1)
  $ 678       2-16     $ 724  
New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) Designated Market Maker (DMM) rights
    440       12       462  
Insurance-related assets (2)
    125       6       155  
Exchange-traded fund (ETF) lead market maker rights
    92       18       95  
Other (3)
    102       1-17       93  
                         
Total
  $ 1,437             $ 1,529  
                         
 
 
(1) Primarily includes our clearance and execution and NASDAQ customer lists related to SLK and financial counseling customer lists related to Ayco.
 
(2) Primarily includes the value of business acquired related to our insurance businesses.
 
(3) Primarily includes marketing-related assets and other contractual rights.
 
 
A prolonged period of weakness in global equity markets and the trading of securities in multiple markets and on multiple exchanges could adversely impact our businesses and impair the value of our identifiable intangible assets. In addition, certain events could indicate a potential impairment of our identifiable intangible assets, including (i) changes in market structure that could adversely affect our specialist businesses (see discussion below), (ii) an adverse action or assessment by a regulator or (iii) adverse actual experience on the contracts in our variable annuity and life insurance business.
 
In October 2008, the SEC approved the NYSE’s proposal to create a new market model and redefine the role of NYSE DMMs. This new rule set further aligns the NYSE’s model with investor requirements for speed and efficiency of execution and establishes specialists as DMMs. While DMMs still have an obligation to commit capital, they are now able to trade on parity with other market participants. In addition, in June 2009 the NYSE successfully completed the rollout of new systems architecture that further reduces order completion time, which enables the NYSE to offer competitive execution speeds, while continuing to incorporate the price discovery provided by DMMs. The new rule set, in combination with technology improvements to increase execution speed, is expected to continue to bolster the NYSE’s competitive position.


98


Table of Contents

Since our last impairment test, there have been no events or changes in circumstances indicating that NYSE DMM rights intangible asset may not be recoverable. However, we will continue to evaluate the performance of the specialist business under the new market model. There can be no assurance that these rule and system changes will result in sufficient cash flows to avoid impairment of our NYSE DMM rights in the future. As of June 2009, the carrying value of our NYSE DMM rights was $440 million. To the extent that there were to be an impairment in the future, it could result in a significant writedown in the carrying value of these DMM rights.
 
Use of Estimates
 
The use of generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make certain estimates and assumptions. In addition to the estimates we make in connection with fair value measurements and the accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, the use of estimates and assumptions is also important in determining provisions for potential losses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings and tax audits.
 
A substantial portion of our compensation and benefits represents discretionary compensation, which are determined at year-end. We believe the most appropriate way to allocate estimated annual discretionary compensation among interim periods is in proportion to the net revenues earned in such periods. In addition to the level of net revenues, our overall compensation expense in any given year is also influenced by, among other factors, prevailing labor markets, business mix and the structure of our share-based compensation programs. Our ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 49.0% for the first half of 2009.
 
We estimate and provide for potential losses that may arise out of litigation and regulatory proceedings to the extent that such losses are probable and can be estimated, in accordance with SFAS No. 5, “Accounting for Contingencies.” We estimate and provide for potential liabilities that may arise out of tax audits to the extent that uncertain tax positions fail to meet the recognition standard of FIN 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes — an Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109.”
 
Significant judgment is required in making these estimates and our final liabilities may ultimately be materially different. Our total estimated liability in respect of litigation and regulatory proceedings is determined on a case-by-case basis and represents an estimate of probable losses after considering, among other factors, the progress of each case or proceeding, our experience and the experience of others in similar cases or proceedings, and the opinions and views of legal counsel. Given the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of our litigation and regulatory matters, particularly in cases or proceedings in which substantial or indeterminate damages or fines are sought, we cannot estimate losses or ranges of losses for cases or proceedings where there is only a reasonable possibility that a loss may be incurred. See “— Legal Proceedings” in Part I, Item 3 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K, and in Part II, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for information on our judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings.
 
Results of Operations
 
The composition of our net revenues has varied over time as financial markets and the scope of our operations have changed. The composition of net revenues can also vary over the shorter term due to fluctuations in U.S. and global economic and market conditions. See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a further discussion of the impact of economic and market conditions on our results of operations.


99


Table of Contents

 
Financial Overview
 
The following table sets forth an overview of our financial results:
 
Financial Overview
($ in millions, except per share amounts)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
Net revenues
  $ 13,761     $ 9,422     $ 23,186     $ 17,757  
Pre-tax earnings
    5,029       2,832       7,658       4,975  
Net earnings
    3,435       2,087       5,249       3,598  
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders
    2,718       2,051       4,377       3,518  
Diluted earnings per common share
    4.93       4.58       8.42       7.81  
Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity (1)
    23.0 %     20.4 %     18.3 %     17.6 %
Diluted earnings per common share, excluding the impact of one-time TARP preferred dividend (2)
  $ 5.71       N/A     $ 9.23       N/A  
Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity, excluding the impact of one-time TARP preferred dividend (2)
    23.8 %     N/A       19.2 %     N/A  
 
 
(1) Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity (ROE) is computed by dividing annualized net earnings applicable to common shareholders by average monthly common shareholders’ equity. The one-time preferred dividend of $426 million related to the repurchase of our TARP preferred stock (calculated as the difference between the carrying value and the redemption value of the preferred stock) was not annualized in the calculation of annualized net earnings applicable to common shareholders since it has no impact on other quarters in the year. The following table sets forth our average common shareholders’ equity:
 
                                 
    Average for the
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
    (in millions)
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 66,870     $ 43,261     $ 65,167     $ 43,076  
Preferred stock
    (14,125 )     (3,100 )     (15,139 )     (3,100 )
                                 
Common shareholders’ equity
  $ 52,745     $ 40,161     $ 50,028     $ 39,976  
                                 
 
(2) We believe that presenting our results excluding the impact of the one-time preferred dividend of $426 million related to the repurchase of our TARP preferred stock is meaningful because it increases the comparability of period-to-period results. The following tables set forth the calculation of net earnings applicable to common shareholders, diluted earnings per common share and average common shareholders’ equity excluding the impact of this one-time preferred dividend:
 
                 
    Three Months
  Six Months
    Ended June   Ended June
    2009   2009
    (in millions, except
    per share amounts)
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders
  $ 2,718     $ 4,377  
Impact of one-time TARP preferred dividend
    426       426  
                 
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders, excluding the impact of one-time TARP preferred dividend
    3,144       4,803  
Divided by: average diluted common shares outstanding
    551.0       520.1  
                 
Diluted earnings per common share, excluding the impact of one-time TARP preferred dividend
  $ 5.71     $ 9.23  
                 
 
                 
    Average for the
    Three Months
  Six Months
    Ended June   Ended June
    2009   2009
    (in millions)
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 66,870     $ 65,167  
Preferred stock
    (14,125 )     (15,139 )
                 
Common shareholders’ equity
    52,745       50,028  
Impact of one-time TARP preferred dividend on average common shareholders’ equity
    107       61  
                 
Common shareholders’ equity, excluding the impact of one-time TARP preferred dividend on average common shareholders’ equity
  $ 52,852     $ 50,089  
                 


100


Table of Contents

Net Revenues
 
Three Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Our net revenues were $13.76 billion for the second quarter of 2009, an increase of 46% compared with the second quarter of 2008, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments, partially offset by significantly lower net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services and lower net revenues in Investment Banking. The increase in Trading and Principal Investments reflected particularly strong results in FICC and Equities, which were both significantly higher than the second quarter of 2008. The increase in FICC reflected particularly strong performances in credit products, interest rate products and currencies, reflecting strength in the client franchise. In addition, net revenues in both mortgages and commodities were higher compared with the second quarter of 2008. In the second quarter of 2009, mortgages included a loss of approximately $700 million on commercial mortgage loans. During the quarter, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, particularly in more liquid products, favorable market opportunities and tighter corporate credit spreads. The increase in Equities reflected significantly higher net revenues in derivatives and, to a lesser extent, principal strategies. In addition, net revenues in shares were solid, but essentially unchanged compared with the second quarter of 2008. Commissions declined compared with the second quarter of 2008. During the quarter, Equities operated in an environment characterized by solid client-driven activity, favorable market opportunities, a significant increase in global equity prices and a decline in volatility levels. Results in Principal Investments were also higher compared with the second quarter of 2008, and included a gain of $948 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, a gain of $343 million from corporate principal investments and a loss of $499 million from real estate principal investments.
 
The decline in Asset Management and Securities Services reflected significantly lower net revenues in both Asset Management and Securities Services compared with the second quarter of 2008. The decrease in Securities Services primarily reflected the impact of lower customer balances compared with the second quarter of 2008. The decrease in Asset Management principally reflected the impact of lower assets under management, due to market depreciation since the end of the second quarter of 2008. During the quarter, assets under management increased $48 billion to $819 billion, due to $42 billion of market appreciation, primarily in equity and fixed income assets, and $6 billion of net inflows.
 
The decline in Investment Banking reflected significantly lower net revenues in Financial Advisory, partially offset by significantly higher net revenues in Underwriting compared with the second quarter of 2008. The decrease in Financial Advisory reflected a significant decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. The increase in Underwriting reflected significantly higher net revenues in equity underwriting, which achieved its highest quarterly performance, as well as higher net revenues in debt underwriting. The increase in equity underwriting reflected very strong client activity. The increase in debt underwriting primarily reflected higher net revenues from investment-grade and municipal activity.


101


Table of Contents

Six Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Our net revenues were $23.19 billion for the six months ended June 2009, an increase of 31% compared with the first half of 2008, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments, partially offset by significantly lower net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services, and Investment Banking. The increase in Trading and Principal Investments reflected significantly higher net revenues in FICC, which were more than double the amount in the first half of 2008, as well as higher net revenues in Equities, partially offset by weak results in Principal Investments. The increase in FICC reflected particularly strong results in credit products, interest rate products and, to a lesser extent, commodities, reflecting strength in the client franchise. In addition, results in mortgages were significantly higher compared with a difficult first half of 2008, while net revenues in currencies were solid, but lower compared with the first half of 2008. In the first half of 2009, mortgages included a loss of approximately $1.5 billion on commercial mortgage loans. During the first half of 2009, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, particularly in more liquid products, and favorable market opportunities. The increase in Equities reflected particularly strong net revenues in derivatives, as well as higher results in principal strategies. These increases were partially offset by lower net revenues in shares compared with the first half of 2008. Commissions declined compared with the first half of 2008. During the first half of 2009, Equities operated in an environment generally characterized by an increase in global equity prices (principally during our second quarter) and high, but declining, levels of volatility. In the first half of 2009, results in Principal Investments reflected net losses of $1.14 billion from real estate principal investments and $278 million from corporate principal investments, partially offset by a gain of $797 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC.
 
The decline in Asset Management and Securities Services reflected significant decreases in both Asset Management and Securities Services. The decrease in Asset Management primarily reflected the impact of lower assets under management, due to market depreciation during the second half of 2008. The decrease in Securities Services primarily reflected the impact of lower customer balances.
 
The decline in Investment Banking primarily reflected significantly lower net revenues in Financial Advisory, due to a significant decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. Net revenues in Underwriting were slightly lower compared with the first half of 2008, primarily due to lower net revenues in debt underwriting, reflecting a decrease in leveraged finance activity. Net revenues in equity underwriting were essentially unchanged compared with the first half of 2008.


102


Table of Contents

Operating Expenses
 
Our operating expenses are primarily influenced by compensation, headcount and levels of business activity. Compensation and benefits expenses includes salaries, estimated year-end discretionary compensation, amortization of equity awards and other items such as payroll taxes, severance costs and benefits. Discretionary compensation is significantly impacted by, among other factors, the level of net revenues, prevailing labor markets, business mix and the structure of our share-based compensation programs. Our ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 49.0% for the first half of 2009.
 
The following table sets forth our operating expenses and total staff:
 
Operating Expenses and Total Staff
($ in millions)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
Compensation and benefits (1)
  $ 6,649     $ 4,522     $ 11,361     $ 8,523  
                                 
Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees
    574       741       1,110       1,531  
Market development
    82       126       150       270  
Communications and technology
    173       192       346       379  
Depreciation and amortization (2)
    426       220       975       474  
Occupancy
    242       234       483       470  
Professional fees
    145       185       280       363  
Other expenses
    441       370       823       772  
                                 
Total non-compensation expenses
    2,083       2,068       4,167       4,259  
                                 
Total operating expenses
  $ 8,732     $ 6,590     $ 15,528     $ 12,782  
                                 
Total staff at period end (3)
    29,400       35,000                  
 
 
(1) Compensation and benefits includes $66 million for both the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008 and $136 million and $129 million for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, attributable to consolidated entities held for investment purposes. Consolidated entities held for investment purposes are entities that are held strictly for capital appreciation, have a defined exit strategy and are engaged in activities that are not closely related to our principal businesses.
 
(2) Beginning in the second quarter of 2009, “Amortization of identifiable intangible assets” is included in “Depreciation and amortization” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. Prior periods have been reclassified to conform to the current presentation.
 
(3) Includes employees, consultants and temporary staff. Excludes total staff of approximately 3,900 and 4,900 as of June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, of consolidated entities held for investment purposes (see footnote 1 above).


103


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth non-compensation expenses of consolidated entities held for investment purposes and our remaining non-compensation expenses by line item:
 
Non-Compensation Expenses
(in millions)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
Non-compensation expenses of consolidated investments (1)
  $ 286     $ 123     $ 746     $ 248  
                                 
Non-compensation expenses excluding consolidated investments
                               
Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees
    574       741       1,110       1,531  
Market development
    80       124       146       265  
Communications and technology
    171       191       343       377  
Depreciation and amortization (2)
    220       184       421       413  
Occupancy
    223       211       431       428  
Professional fees
    143       181       276       357  
Other expenses
    386       313       694       640  
                                 
Subtotal
    1,797       1,945       3,421       4,011  
                                 
Total non-compensation expenses, as reported
  $ 2,083     $ 2,068     $ 4,167     $ 4,259  
                                 
 
 
(1) Consolidated entities held for investment purposes are entities that are held strictly for capital appreciation, have a defined exit strategy and are engaged in activities that are not closely related to our principal businesses. For example, these investments include consolidated entities that hold real estate assets, such as hotels, but exclude investments in entities that primarily hold financial assets. We believe that it is meaningful to review non-compensation expenses excluding expenses related to these consolidated entities in order to evaluate trends in non-compensation expenses related to our principal business activities. Revenues related to such entities are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
(2) Beginning in the second quarter of 2009, “Amortization of identifiable intangible assets” is included in “Depreciation and amortization” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. Prior periods have been reclassified to conform to the current presentation.
 
 
Three Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Operating expenses of $8.73 billion for the second quarter of 2009 increased 33% compared with the second quarter of 2008. Compensation and benefits expenses (including salaries, estimated year-end discretionary compensation, amortization of equity awards and other items such as payroll taxes, severance costs and benefits) of $6.65 billion were higher than the second quarter of 2008, primarily due to higher net revenues. During the second quarter of 2009, our ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 48.3%. Total staff decreased 1% during the second quarter of 2009.


104


Table of Contents

Non-compensation expenses, excluding consolidated entities held for investment purposes, were $1.80 billion, 8% lower than the second quarter of 2008. The decrease compared with the second quarter of 2008 was attributable to lower brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, principally reflecting lower transaction volumes in Equities. In addition, non-compensation expenses during the second quarter of 2009 were generally lower than the second quarter of 2008 principally due to the impact of reduced staff levels and the effect of expense reduction initiatives. These decreases were partially offset by the impact of higher FDIC fees on bank deposits, including the impact of a special assessment of approximately $50 million, and net provisions for litigation and regulatory proceedings of $25 million. The increase in non-compensation expenses related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes reflected real estate impairment charges of approximately $170 million during the second quarter of 2009. This loss, which was measured based on discounted cash flow analysis, is included in our Trading and Principal Investments segment and reflected weakness in the commercial real estate markets, particularly in Asia. Including consolidated entities held for investment purposes, non-compensation expenses were $2.08 billion, essentially unchanged from the second quarter of 2008.
 
Six Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Operating expenses of $15.53 billion for the first half of 2009 increased 21% compared with the first half of 2008. Compensation and benefits expenses (including salaries, estimated year-end discretionary compensation, amortization of equity awards and other items such as payroll taxes, severance costs and benefits) of $11.36 billion were higher than the first half of 2008, primarily due to higher net revenues. Our ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 49.0% for the first half of 2009. Total staff decreased 7% during the first half of 2009.
 
Non-compensation expenses, excluding consolidated entities held for investment purposes, were $3.42 billion, 15% lower than the first half of 2008. The decrease compared with the first half of 2008 was primarily attributable to lower brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, principally reflecting lower transaction volumes in Equities. The remainder of the decrease compared with the first half of 2008 generally reflected the impact of reduced staff levels and the effect of expense reduction initiatives. The increase in non-compensation expenses related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes reflected real estate impairment charges of approximately $470 million during the first half of 2009. These losses, which were measured based on discounted cash flow analysis, are included in our Trading and Principal Investments segment and reflected weakness in the commercial real estate markets, particularly in Asia. Including consolidated entities held for investment purposes, non-compensation expenses were $4.17 billion, 2% lower than the first half of 2008.
 
Provision for Taxes
 
The effective income tax rate for the first half of 2009 was 31.5%, up slightly from 31.0% for the first quarter of 2009. The effective income tax rate for fiscal year 2008 was approximately 1%. The increase in the effective tax rate from 2008 was primarily due to changes in geographic earnings mix. During 2008, we incurred losses in various U.S. and non-U.S. entities whose income/(losses) are subject to tax in the U.S. We also had profitable operations in certain non-U.S. entities that are taxed at their applicable local tax rates, which are generally lower than the U.S. rate. The effective tax rate for the first half of 2009 represents a return to a geographic earnings mix that is more in line with our historic earnings mix.


105


Table of Contents

 
Segment Operating Results
 
The following table sets forth the net revenues, operating expenses and pre-tax earnings of our segments:
 
Segment Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                                     
        Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
        June
  May
  June
  May
        2009   2008   2009   2008
 
Investment
  Net revenues   $ 1,440     $ 1,685     $ 2,263     $ 2,857  
Banking
  Operating expenses     1,167       1,155       1,872       2,095  
                                     
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 273     $ 530     $ 391     $ 762  
                                     
Trading and Principal
  Net revenues   $ 10,784     $ 5,591     $ 17,934     $ 10,715  
Investments
  Operating expenses     6,290       3,961       11,163       7,704  
                                     
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 4,494     $ 1,630     $ 6,771     $ 3,011  
                                     
Asset Management and
  Net revenues   $ 1,537     $ 2,146     $ 2,989     $ 4,185  
Securities Services
  Operating expenses     1,250       1,477       2,455       2,970  
                                     
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 287     $ 669     $ 534     $ 1,215  
                                     
Total
  Net revenues   $ 13,761     $ 9,422     $ 23,186     $ 17,757  
    Operating expenses (1)     8,732       6,590       15,528       12,782  
                                     
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 5,029     $ 2,832     $ 7,658     $ 4,975  
                                     
 
 
(1) Operating expenses include net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings of $25 million and $(3) million for the three months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, and $38 million and $13 million for the six months ended June 2009 and May 2008, respectively, that have not been allocated to our segments.
 
 
Net revenues in our segments include allocations of interest income and interest expense to specific securities, commodities and other positions in relation to the cash generated by, or funding requirements of, such underlying positions. See Note 16 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our business segments.
 
The cost drivers of Goldman Sachs taken as a whole — compensation, headcount and levels of business activity — are broadly similar in each of our business segments. Compensation and benefits expenses within our segments reflect, among other factors, the overall performance of Goldman Sachs as well as the performance of individual business units. Consequently, pre-tax margins in one segment of our business may be significantly affected by the performance of our other business segments. A discussion of segment operating results follows.


106


Table of Contents

Investment Banking
 
Our Investment Banking segment is divided into two components:
 
  •  Financial Advisory.  Financial Advisory includes advisory assignments with respect to mergers and acquisitions, divestitures, corporate defense activities, restructurings and spin-offs.
 
  •  Underwriting.  Underwriting includes public offerings and private placements of a wide range of securities and other financial instruments.
 
The following table sets forth the operating results of our Investment Banking segment:
 
Investment Banking Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
Financial Advisory
  $ 368     $ 800     $ 895     $ 1,463  
                                 
Equity underwriting
    736       616       784       788  
Debt underwriting
    336       269       584       606  
                                 
Total Underwriting
    1,072       885       1,368       1,394  
                                 
Total net revenues
    1,440       1,685       2,263       2,857  
Operating expenses
    1,167       1,155       1,872       2,095  
                                 
Pre-tax earnings
  $ 273     $ 530     $ 391     $ 762  
                                 
 
 
The following table sets forth our financial advisory and underwriting transaction volumes:
 
Goldman Sachs Global Investment Banking Volumes (1)
(in billions)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
Announced mergers and acquisitions
  $ 183     $ 339     $ 350     $ 480  
Completed mergers and acquisitions
    71       257       299       400  
Equity and equity-related offerings (2)
    32       20       34       30  
Debt offerings (3)
    82       68       160       129  
 
 
(1) Source: Thomson Reuters. Announced and completed mergers and acquisitions volumes are based on full credit to each of the advisors in a transaction. Equity and equity-related offerings and debt offerings are based on full credit for single book managers and equal credit for joint book managers. Transaction volumes may not be indicative of net revenues in a given period. In addition, transaction volumes for prior periods may vary from amounts previously reported due to the subsequent withdrawal or a change in the value of a transaction.
 
(2) Includes Rule 144A and public common stock offerings, convertible offerings and rights offerings.
 
(3) Includes non-convertible preferred stock, mortgage-backed securities, asset-backed securities and taxable municipal debt. Includes publicly registered and Rule 144A issues.


107


Table of Contents

Three Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Net revenues in Investment Banking of $1.44 billion for the second quarter of 2009 decreased 15% compared with the second quarter of 2008.
 
Net revenues in Financial Advisory of $368 million decreased 54% compared with the second quarter of 2008, primarily reflecting a significant decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. Net revenues in our Underwriting business of $1.07 billion increased 21% compared with the second quarter of 2008, due to significantly higher net revenues in equity underwriting, as well as higher net revenues in debt underwriting. The increase in equity underwriting reflected very strong client activity. The increase in debt underwriting primarily reflected higher net revenues from investment-grade and municipal activity. Our investment banking transaction backlog decreased during the quarter. (1)
 
Operating expenses of $1.17 billion for the second quarter of 2009 were essentially unchanged compared with the second quarter of 2008. Pre-tax earnings of $273 million in the second quarter of 2009 decreased 48% compared with the second quarter of 2008.
 
Six Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Net revenues in Investment Banking of $2.26 billion for the first half of 2009 decreased 21% compared with the first half of 2008.
 
Net revenues in Financial Advisory of $895 million decreased 39% compared with the first half of 2008, reflecting a significant decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. Net revenues in our Underwriting business of $1.37 billion decreased 2% compared with the first half of 2008, primarily due to lower net revenues in debt underwriting, reflecting a decrease in leveraged finance activity. Net revenues in equity underwriting were essentially unchanged compared with the first half of 2008.
 
Operating expenses of $1.87 billion for the first half of 2009 decreased 11% compared with the first half of 2008, due to decreased non-compensation expenses, principally due to lower activity levels, and decreased compensation and benefits expenses resulting from lower net revenues. Pre-tax earnings of $391 million in the first half of 2009 decreased 49% compared with the first half of 2008.
 
Trading and Principal Investments
 
Our Trading and Principal Investments segment is divided into three components:
 
  •  FICC.  We make markets in and trade interest rate and credit products, mortgage-related securities and loan products and other asset-backed instruments, currencies and commodities, structure and enter into a wide variety of derivative transactions, and engage in proprietary trading and investing.
 
  •  Equities.  We make markets in and trade equities and equity-related products, structure and enter into equity derivative transactions and engage in proprietary trading. We generate commissions from executing and clearing client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide through our Equities client franchise and clearing activities. We also engage in specialist and insurance activities.
 
  •  Principal Investments.  We make real estate and corporate principal investments, including our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC. We generate net revenues from returns on these investments and from the increased share of the income and gains derived from our merchant banking funds when the return on a fund’s investments over the life of the fund exceeds certain threshold returns (typically referred to as an override).
 
 
(1)   Our investment banking transaction backlog represents an estimate of our future net revenues from investment banking
  transactions where we believe that future revenue realization is more likely than not.


108


Table of Contents

 
Substantially all of our inventory is marked-to-market daily and, therefore, its value and our net revenues are subject to fluctuations based on market movements. In addition, net revenues derived from our principal investments, including those in privately held concerns and in real estate, may fluctuate significantly depending on the revaluation of these investments in any given period. We also regularly enter into large transactions as part of our trading businesses. The number and size of such transactions may affect our results of operations in a given period.
 
Net revenues from Principal Investments do not include management fees generated from our merchant banking funds. These management fees are included in the net revenues of the Asset Management and Securities Services segment.
 
The following table sets forth the operating results of our Trading and Principal Investments segment:
 
Trading and Principal Investments Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
FICC
  $ 6,795     $ 2,379     $ 13,352     $ 5,521  
                                 
Equities trading
    2,157       1,253       3,184       2,529  
Equities commissions
    1,021       1,234       1,995       2,472  
                                 
Total Equities
    3,178       2,487       5,179       5,001  
                                 
ICBC
    948       214       797       79  
                                 
Gross gains
    1,306       979       1,812       1,336  
Gross losses
    (1,462 )     (503 )     (3,229 )     (1,270 )
                                 
Net other corporate and real estate investments
    (156 )     476       (1,417 )     66  
Overrides
    19       35       23       48  
                                 
                                 
Total Principal Investments
    811       725       (597 )     193  
                                 
Total net revenues
    10,784       5,591       17,934       10,715  
Operating expenses
    6,290       3,961       11,163       7,704  
                                 
Pre-tax earnings
  $ 4,494     $ 1,630     $ 6,771     $ 3,011  
                                 
 
 
Three Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments of $10.78 billion increased 93% compared with the second quarter of 2008.
 
Net revenues in FICC of $6.80 billion increased significantly compared with the second quarter of 2008. These results reflected particularly strong performances in credit products, interest rate products and currencies, reflecting strength in the client franchise. In addition, net revenues in both mortgages and commodities were higher compared with the second quarter of 2008. In the second quarter of 2009, mortgages included a loss of approximately $700 million on commercial mortgage loans. During the quarter, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, particularly in more liquid products, favorable market opportunities and tighter corporate credit spreads.
 
Net revenues in Equities of $3.18 billion increased 28% compared with the second quarter of 2008, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in derivatives and, to a lesser extent, principal strategies. In addition, net revenues in shares were solid, but essentially unchanged compared with the second quarter of 2008. Commissions declined compared with the second quarter of 2008. During the quarter, Equities operated in an environment characterized by solid client-driven activity, favorable market opportunities, a significant increase in global equity prices and a decline in volatility levels.


109


Table of Contents

 
Principal Investments recorded net revenues of $811 million for the second quarter of 2009. These results included a gain of $948 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, a gain of $343 million from corporate principal investments and a loss of $499 million from real estate principal investments.
 
Operating expenses of $6.29 billion for the second quarter of 2009 increased 59% compared with the second quarter of 2008, due to increased compensation and benefits expenses resulting from higher net revenues, and real estate impairment charges during the second quarter of 2009 of approximately $170 million related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes. These increases were partially offset by lower brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, principally reflecting lower transaction volumes in Equities. Pre-tax earnings were $4.49 billion in the second quarter of 2009 compared with $1.63 billion in the second quarter of 2008.
 
Six Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments of $17.93 billion increased 67% compared with the first half of 2008.
 
Net revenues in FICC of $13.35 billion were more than double the amount in the first half of 2008. These results reflected particularly strong results in credit products, interest rate products and, to a lesser extent, commodities, reflecting strength in the client franchise. In addition, results in mortgages were significantly higher compared with a difficult first half of 2008, while net revenues in currencies were solid, but lower compared with the first half of 2008. In the first half of 2009, mortgages included a loss of approximately $1.5 billion on commercial mortgage loans. During the first half of 2009, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, particularly in more liquid products, and favorable market opportunities.
 
Net revenues in Equities of $5.18 billion increased 4% compared with the first half of 2008, reflecting particularly strong net revenues in derivatives, as well as higher results in principal strategies. These increases were partially offset by lower net revenues in shares compared with the first half of 2008. Commissions declined compared with the first half of 2008. During the first half of 2009, Equities operated in an environment generally characterized by an increase in global equity prices (principally during our second quarter) and high, but declining, levels of volatility.
 
Principal Investments recorded a net loss of $597 million for the first half of 2009. These results included net losses of $1.14 billion from real estate principal investments and $278 million from corporate principal investments, partially offset by a gain of $797 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC.
 
Operating expenses of $11.16 billion for the first half of 2009 increased 45% compared with the first half of 2008, due to increased compensation and benefits expenses resulting from higher net revenues, and real estate impairment charges during the first half of 2009 of approximately $470 million related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes. These increases were partially offset by lower brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, principally reflecting lower transaction volumes in Equities. Pre-tax earnings were $6.77 billion in the first half of 2009 compared with $3.01 billion in the first half of 2008.
 
Asset Management and Securities Services
 
Our Asset Management and Securities Services segment is divided into two components:
 
  •  Asset Management.  Asset Management provides investment advisory and financial planning services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and primarily generates revenues in the form of management and incentive fees.
 
  •  Securities Services.  Securities Services provides prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and to high-net-worth individuals worldwide, and generates revenues primarily in the form of interest rate spreads or fees.


110


Table of Contents

 
Assets under management typically generate fees as a percentage of asset value, which is affected by investment performance and by inflows and redemptions. The fees that we charge vary by asset class, as do our related expenses. In certain circumstances, we are also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s return or when the return on assets under management exceeds specified benchmark returns or other performance targets. Incentive fees are recognized when the performance period ends and they are no longer subject to adjustment. We have numerous incentive fee arrangements, many of which have annual performance periods that end on December 31.
 
The following table sets forth the operating results of our Asset Management and Securities Services segment:
 
Asset Management and Securities Services Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
    2009   2008   2009   2008
Management and other fees
  $ 918     $ 1,153     $ 1,849     $ 2,276  
Incentive fees
    4       8       22       202  
                                 
Total Asset Management
    922       1,161       1,871       2,478  
Securities Services
    615       985       1,118       1,707  
                                 
Total net revenues
    1,537       2,146       2,989       4,185  
Operating expenses
    1,250       1,477       2,455       2,970  
                                 
Pre-tax earnings
  $ 287     $ 669     $ 534     $ 1,215  
                                 
 
 
Assets under management include our mutual funds, alternative investment funds and separately managed accounts for institutional and individual investors. Substantially all assets under management are valued as of calendar month-end. Assets under management do not include:
 
  •  assets in brokerage accounts that generate commissions, mark-ups and spreads based on transactional activity;
 
  •  our own investments in funds that we manage; or
 
  •  non-fee-paying assets, including interest-bearing deposits held through our depository institution subsidiaries.
 
The following table sets forth our assets under management by asset class:
 
Assets Under Management by Asset Class
(in billions)
 
                                 
    As of
    June 30,
  May 31,
  November 30,
   
2009
 
2008
 
2008
 
2007
Alternative investments (1)
  $ 142     $ 146     $ 146     $ 151  
Equity
    121       211       112       255  
Fixed income
    272       269       248       256  
                                 
Total non-money market assets
    535       626       506       662  
Money markets
    284       269       273       206  
                                 
Total assets under management
  $ 819  (2)   $ 895     $ 779     $ 868  
                                 
 
 
(1) Primarily includes hedge funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities and asset allocation strategies.
 
(2) Excludes the federal agency pass-through mortgage-backed securities account managed for the Federal Reserve.


111


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth a summary of the changes in our assets under management:
 
Changes in Assets Under Management
(in billions)
 
                                 
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June 30,
  May 31,
  June 30,
  May 31,
   
2009
 
2008
 
2009
 
2008
Balance, beginning of period
  $ 771     $ 873     $ 798     $ 868  
                                 
Net inflows/(outflows)
                               
Alternative investments
    (2 )     (3 )     (4 )     (5 )
Equity
    (1 )     (18 )     (2 )     (35 )
Fixed income
    6       10       3       12  
                                 
Total non-money market net inflows/(outflows)
    3       (11 )     (3 )     (28 )
Money markets
    3       17       (2 )     63  
                                 
Total net inflows/(outflows)
    6  (1)     6       (5 (1)     35  
                                 
Net market appreciation/(depreciation)
    42       16       26       (8 )
                                 
Balance, end of period
  $ 819     $ 895     $ 819     $ 895  
                                 
 
 
(1) Excludes the federal agency pass-through mortgage-backed securities account managed for the Federal Reserve.
 
 
Three Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services of $1.54 billion were 28% lower compared with the second quarter of 2008.
 
Asset Management net revenues of $922 million were 21% lower than the second quarter of 2008, primarily reflecting lower assets under management, due to market depreciation since the end of the second quarter of 2008. During the quarter, assets under management increased $48 billion to $819 billion, due to $42 billion of market appreciation, primarily in equity and fixed income assets, and $6 billion of net inflows.
 
Securities Services net revenues of $615 million were 38% lower than the second quarter of 2008. The decrease in net revenues primarily reflected the impact of lower customer balances.
 
Operating expenses of $1.25 billion for the second quarter of 2009 decreased 15% compared with the second quarter of 2008, primarily due to decreased compensation and benefits expenses resulting from lower net revenues. Pre-tax earnings of $287 million decreased 57% compared with the second quarter of 2008.
 
Six Months Ended June 2009 versus May 2008.  Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services of $2.99 billion were 29% lower compared with the first half of 2008.
 
Asset Management net revenues of $1.87 billion were 24% lower than the first half of 2008, primarily reflecting the impact of lower assets under management, due to market depreciation during the second half of 2008. During the first half of 2009, assets under management increased $21 billion, reflecting $26 billion of market appreciation, primarily in fixed income and equity assets, partially offset by $5 billion of net outflows.
 
Securities Services net revenues of $1.12 billion were 35% lower than the first half of 2008. The decrease in net revenues primarily reflected the impact of lower customer balances.


112


Table of Contents

Operating expenses of $2.46 billion for the first half of 2009 decreased 17% compared with the first half of 2008. The decrease primarily reflected decreased compensation and benefits expenses resulting from lower net revenues, and lower distribution fees, primarily reflecting lower assets under management, principally due to market depreciation during the second half of 2008. Pre-tax earnings of $534 million decreased 56% compared with the first half of 2008.
 
Geographic Data
 
See Note 16 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for a summary of our total net revenues and pre-tax earnings by geographic region.
 
Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangements
 
We have various types of off-balance-sheet arrangements that we enter into in the ordinary course of business. Our involvement in these arrangements can take many different forms, including purchasing or retaining residual and other interests in mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securitization vehicles; holding senior and subordinated debt, interests in limited and general partnerships, and preferred and common stock in other nonconsolidated vehicles; entering into interest rate, foreign currency, equity, commodity and credit derivatives, including total return swaps; entering into operating leases; and providing guarantees, indemnifications, loan commitments, letters of credit and representations and warranties.
 
We enter into these arrangements for a variety of business purposes, including the securitization of commercial and residential mortgages, government and corporate bonds, and other types of financial assets. Other reasons for entering into these arrangements include underwriting client securitization transactions; providing secondary market liquidity; making investments in performing and nonperforming debt, equity, real estate and other assets; providing investors with credit-linked and asset-repackaged notes; and receiving or providing letters of credit to satisfy margin requirements and to facilitate the clearance and settlement process.
 
We engage in transactions with variable interest entities (VIEs) and qualifying special-purpose entities (QSPEs). Asset-backed financing vehicles are critical to the functioning of several significant investor markets, including the mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securities markets, since they offer investors access to specific cash flows and risks created through the securitization process. Our financial interests in, and derivative transactions with, such nonconsolidated entities are accounted for at fair value, in the same manner as our other financial instruments, except in cases where we apply the equity method of accounting.
 
We did not have off-balance-sheet commitments to purchase or finance any CDOs held by structured investment vehicles as of June 2009 or November 2008.
 
In December 2007, the American Securitization Forum (ASF) issued the “Streamlined Foreclosure and Loss Avoidance Framework for Securitized Subprime Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans” (ASF Framework). The ASF Framework provides guidance for servicers to streamline borrower evaluation procedures and to facilitate the use of foreclosure and loss prevention measures for securitized subprime residential mortgages that meet certain criteria. For certain eligible loans as defined in the ASF Framework, servicers may presume default is reasonably foreseeable and apply a fast-track loan modification plan, under which the loan interest rate will be kept at the then current rate for a period up to five years following the upcoming reset date. Mortgage loan modifications of these eligible loans will not affect our accounting treatment for QSPEs that hold the subprime loans.


113


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth where a discussion of off-balance-sheet arrangements may be found in Part I, Items 1 and 2 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q:
 
     
Type of Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangement   Disclosure in Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q
 
 
     
Retained interests or other continuing involvement relating to assets transferred by us to nonconsolidated entities   See Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q.
     
Leases, letters of credit, and loans and other commitments   See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q and “— Contractual Obligations” below.
     
Guarantees   See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q.
     
Other obligations, including contingent obligations, arising out of variable interests we have in nonconsolidated entities   See Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q.
     
Derivative contracts   See “— Critical Accounting Policies” above, and “— Risk Management” and “— Derivatives” below and Notes 3 and 7 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q.
     
 
 
 
In addition, see Note 2 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for a discussion of our consolidation policies and for information regarding amendments to FIN 46-R, “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities,” and SFAS No. 140, “Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities.”
 
Equity Capital
 
The level and composition of our equity capital are principally determined by our consolidated regulatory capital requirements but may also be influenced by rating agency guidelines, subsidiary capital requirements, the business environment, conditions in the financial markets and assessments of potential future losses due to extreme and adverse changes in our business and market environments. As of June 2009, our total shareholders’ equity was $62.81 billion (consisting of common shareholders’ equity of $55.86 billion and preferred stock of $6.96 billion). As of November 2008, our total shareholders’ equity was $64.37 billion (consisting of common shareholders’ equity of $47.90 billion and preferred stock of $16.47 billion). In addition to total shareholders’ equity, we consider our $5.00 billion of junior subordinated debt issued to trusts to be part of our equity capital, as it qualifies as capital for regulatory and certain rating agency purposes.


114


Table of Contents

Consolidated Capital Requirements
 
The Federal Reserve Board is the primary U.S. regulator of Group Inc. As a bank holding company, we are subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve Board. Our bank depository institution subsidiaries, including GS Bank USA, are subject to similar capital requirements. Under the Federal Reserve Board’s capital adequacy requirements and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action (PCA) that is applicable to GS Bank USA, Goldman Sachs and its bank depository institution subsidiaries must meet specific capital requirements that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory reporting practices. Goldman Sachs and its bank depository institution subsidiaries’ capital levels, as well as GS Bank USA’s PCA classification, are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.
 
We are reporting capital ratios in accordance with the regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies, which are based on the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel I). These ratios are used by the Federal Reserve Board and other U.S. Federal banking agencies in the supervisory review process, including the assessment of our capital adequacy.
 
We also continue to disclose our capital ratios in accordance with the capital guidelines applicable to us before we became a bank holding company in September 2008, when we were regulated by the SEC as a Consolidated Supervised Entity (CSE). These guidelines were generally consistent with those set out in the Revised Framework for the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel II). Subsequent to becoming a bank holding company, we no longer report the CSE capital ratios to the SEC and Group Inc. is no longer regulated as a CSE.
 
Our capital ratios are set forth under “— Capital Ratios and Metrics” below. See Note 15 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part 1, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for information regarding our capital ratios calculated in accordance with the Federal Reserve Board’s regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies, which are based on Basel I, and our capital ratios calculated in accordance with the capital guidelines applicable to us before we became a bank holding company in September 2008, when we were regulated by the SEC as a CSE, which were generally consistent with guidelines set out in Basel II.
 
Subsidiary Capital Requirements
 
Many of our subsidiaries are subject to separate regulation and capital requirements in jurisdictions throughout the world. Goldman, Sachs & Co. (GS&Co.) and Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P. are registered U.S. broker-dealers and futures commission merchants, and are subject to regulatory capital requirements, including those imposed by the SEC, the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, the Chicago Board of Trade, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. (FINRA) and the National Futures Association.
 
GS Bank USA, a New York State-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System and the FDIC, is regulated by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Banking Department (NYSBD) and is subject to minimum capital requirements that (subject to certain exceptions) are similar to those applicable to bank holding companies. GS Bank USA computes its capital ratios in accordance with the regulatory capital guidelines currently applicable to state member banks, which are based on Basel I as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board, for purposes of assessing the adequacy of its capital. See Note 15 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part 1, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for information regarding GS Bank USA’s capital ratios under Basel I as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board, and for further information regarding the capital requirements of our other regulated subsidiaries.


115


Table of Contents

Subsidiaries not subject to separate regulation may hold capital to satisfy local tax guidelines, rating agency requirements (for entities with assigned credit ratings) or internal policies, including policies concerning the minimum amount of capital a subsidiary should hold based on its underlying level of risk. See “— Liquidity and Funding Risk — Conservative Liability Structure” below for a discussion of our potential inability to access funds from our subsidiaries.
 
Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of GS&Co., GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe, subject to certain exceptions. In November 2008, we contributed subsidiaries into GS Bank USA, and Group Inc. agreed to guarantee certain losses, including credit-related losses, relating to assets held by the contributed entities. In connection with this guarantee, Group Inc. also agreed to pledge to GS Bank USA certain collateral, including interests in subsidiaries and other illiquid assets.
 
Equity investments in subsidiaries are generally funded with parent company equity capital, commensurate with the entity’s risk of loss. As of June 2009 and November 2008, Group Inc.’s equity investment in subsidiaries was $58.90 billion and $51.70 billion, respectively, compared with its total shareholders’ equity of $62.81 billion and $64.37 billion.
 
Our capital invested in non-U.S. subsidiaries is generally exposed to foreign exchange risk, substantially all of which is managed through a combination of derivative contracts and non-U.S. denominated debt. In addition, we generally manage the non-trading exposure to foreign exchange risk that arises from transactions denominated in currencies other than the transacting entity’s functional currency.
 
Rating Agency Guidelines
 
The credit rating agencies assign credit ratings to the obligations of Group Inc., which directly issues or guarantees substantially all of the firm’s senior unsecured obligations. In addition, GS Bank USA has been assigned a long-term issuer rating as well as ratings on its long-term and short-term bank deposits. The level and composition of our equity capital are among the many factors considered in determining our credit ratings. Each agency has its own definition of eligible capital and methodology for evaluating capital adequacy, and assessments are generally based on a combination of factors rather than a single calculation. See “— Liquidity and Funding Risk — Credit Ratings” below for further information regarding our credit ratings.
 
Equity Capital Management
 
Our objective is to maintain a sufficient level and optimal composition of equity capital. We manage our capital through repurchases of our common stock and issuances of common and preferred stock, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts and other subordinated debt. We manage our capital requirements principally by setting limits on balance sheet assets and/or limits on risk, in each case at both the consolidated and business unit levels. We attribute capital usage to each of our business units based upon our regulatory capital framework and manage the levels of usage based upon the balance sheet and risk limits established.
 
Stock Offering.  During the second quarter of 2009, we completed a public offering of 46.7 million common shares at $123.00 per share for total proceeds of $5.75 billion.
 
Preferred Stock.  In June 2009, we repurchased from the U.S. Department of the Treasury (U.S. Treasury) the 10.0 million shares of our Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series H, that were issued to the U.S. Treasury pursuant to the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program. The aggregate purchase price paid by us to the U.S. Treasury for the Preferred Stock, including accrued dividends, was $10.04 billion. Upon repurchase of the Series H Preferred Stock in June 2009, we were no longer subject to the limit on common stock repurchases imposed under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program.


116


Table of Contents

Share Repurchase Program.  We seek to use our share repurchase program to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity and to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employee share-based compensation. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by our current and projected capital positions (i.e., comparisons of our desired level of capital to our actual level of capital) but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of our common stock.
 
As of June 2009, we were authorized to repurchase up to 60.8 million additional shares of common stock pursuant to our repurchase program. See “Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds” in Part II, Item 2 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for additional information on our repurchase program.
 
See Note 9 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part 1, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our preferred stock, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts and other subordinated debt.
 
Capital Ratios and Metrics
 
The following table sets forth information on our assets, shareholders’ equity, leverage ratios, capital ratios and book value per common share:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    ($ in millions, except
    per share amounts)
Total assets
  $ 889,544     $ 884,547  
Adjusted assets (1)
    553,021       528,292  
Total shareholders’ equity
    62,813       64,369  
Tangible equity capital (2)
    62,840       64,317  
Leverage ratio (3)
    14.2 x     13.7 x
Adjusted leverage ratio (4)
    8.8 x     8.2 x
Debt to equity ratio (5)
    3.0 x     2.6 x
Common shareholders’ equity
  $ 55,856     $ 47,898  
Tangible common shareholders’ equity (6)
    50,883       42,846  
Basel I (7)
               
Tier 1 capital ratio
    13.8 %     N/A  
Total capital ratio
    17.2 %     N/A  
Tier 1 leverage ratio
    6.4 %     N/A  
Tier 1 common ratio (8)
    10.9 %     N/A  
Tangible common shareholders’ equity to risk-weighted assets ratio
    12.4 %     N/A  
Basel II (9)
               
Tier 1 capital ratio
    16.1 %     15.6 %
Total capital ratio
    19.7 %     18.9 %
Tier 1 common ratio (8)
    13.0 %     10.3 %
Tangible common shareholders’ equity to risk-weighted assets ratio
    13.3 %     10.7 %
Book value per common share (10)
  $ 106.41     $ 98.68  
Tangible book value per common share (11)
    96.94       88.27  
 
 
(1) Adjusted assets excludes (i) low-risk collateralized assets generally associated with our matched book and securities lending businesses and federal funds sold, (ii) cash and securities we segregate for regulatory and other purposes and (iii) goodwill and identifiable intangible assets which are deducted when calculating tangible equity capital (see footnote 2 below).


117


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total assets to adjusted assets:
 
                     
        As of
        June
  November
        2009   2008
        (in millions)
Total assets
  $ 889,544     $ 884,547  
Deduct:
  Securities borrowed     (218,544 )     (180,795 )
    Securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold     (138,339 )     (122,021 )
Add:
  Trading liabilities, at fair value     147,297       175,972  
    Less derivative liabilities     (68,151 )     (117,695 )
                     
    Subtotal     79,146       58,277  
Deduct:
  Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes     (53,813 )     (106,664 )
    Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets     (4,973 )     (5,052 )
                     
Adjusted assets
  $ 553,021     $ 528,292  
                 
 
(2) Tangible equity capital equals total shareholders’ equity and junior subordinated debt issued to trusts less goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. We consider junior subordinated debt issued to trusts to be a component of our tangible equity capital base due to certain characteristics of the debt, including its long-term nature, our ability to defer payments due on the debt and the subordinated nature of the debt in our capital structure.
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity to tangible equity capital:
 
                     
        As of
        June
  November
        2009   2008
        (in millions)
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 62,813     $ 64,369  
Add:
  Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts     5,000       5,000  
Deduct:
  Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets     (4,973 )     (5,052 )
                     
Tangible equity capital
  $ 62,840     $ 64,317  
                 
 
(3) The leverage ratio equals total assets divided by total shareholders’ equity. This ratio is different from the Tier 1 leverage ratios included above and is described in Note 15 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part 1, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q.
 
(4) The adjusted leverage ratio equals adjusted assets divided by tangible equity capital. We believe that the adjusted leverage ratio is a more meaningful measure of our capital adequacy than the leverage ratio because it excludes certain low-risk collateralized assets that are generally supported with little or no capital and reflects the tangible equity capital deployed in our businesses.
 
(5) The debt to equity ratio equals unsecured long-term borrowings divided by total shareholders’ equity.
 
(6) Tangible common shareholders’ equity equals total shareholders’ equity less preferred stock, goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. We believe that tangible common shareholders’ equity is meaningful because it is one of the measures that we and investors use to assess capital adequacy.
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity to tangible common shareholders’ equity:
 
                     
        As of
        June
  November
        2009   2008
        (in millions)
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 62,813     $ 64,369  
Deduct:
  Preferred stock     (6,957 )     (16,471 )
                     
Common shareholders’ equity
    55,856       47,898  
Deduct:
  Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets     (4,973 )     (5,052 )
                     
Tangible common shareholders’ equity
  $ 50,883     $ 42,846  
                 
 
(7) Calculated in accordance with the regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies. Risk-weighted assets were $409.20 billion as of June 2009 under Basel I. See Note 15 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part 1, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our regulatory capital ratios.
 
(8) The Tier 1 common ratio equals Tier 1 capital less preferred stock and junior subordinated debt issued to trusts, divided by risk-weighted assets.
 
(9) Calculated in accordance with the capital guidelines applicable to us when we were regulated by the SEC as a CSE. Risk-weighted assets were $381.84 billion and $400.38 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, under Basel II. See Note 15 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part 1, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our regulatory capital ratios.


118


Table of Contents

(10) Book value per common share is based on common shares outstanding, including restricted stock units granted to employees with no future service requirements, of 524.9 million and 485.4 million and as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(11) Tangible book value per common share is computed by dividing tangible common shareholders’ equity by the number of common shares outstanding, including restricted stock units granted to employees with no future service requirements.
 
 
Contractual Obligations
 
Goldman Sachs has contractual obligations to make future payments related to our unsecured long-term borrowings, secured long-term financings, long-term noncancelable lease agreements and purchase obligations and has commitments under a variety of commercial arrangements.
 
The following table sets forth our contractual obligations by fiscal maturity date as of June 2009:
 
Contractual Obligations
(in millions)
 
                                         
    Remainder
  2010-
  2012-
  2014-
   
   
of 2009
 
2011
 
2013
 
Thereafter
 
Total
Unsecured long-term borrowings (1)(2)(3)
  $     $ 33,069     $ 49,541     $ 108,632     $ 191,242  
Secured long-term financings (1)(2)(4)
          6,879       4,753       4,426       16,058  
Contractual interest payments (5)
    3,656       13,480       10,860       33,060       61,056  
Insurance liabilities (6)
    526       2,561       891       7,172       11,150  
Minimum rental payments
    249       826       570       1,780       3,425  
Purchase obligations
    470       147       27       24       668  
 
 
(1) Obligations maturing within one year of our financial statement date or redeemable within one year of our financial statement date at the option of the holder are excluded from this table and are treated as short-term obligations. See Note 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our secured financings.
 
(2) Obligations that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of Goldman Sachs are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Obligations that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.
 
(3) Includes $19.90 billion accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155 or SFAS No. 159, primarily consisting of hybrid financial instruments and prepaid physical commodity transactions.
 
(4) These obligations are reported within “Other secured financings” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and include $10.67 billion accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159.
 
(5) Represents estimated future interest payments related to unsecured long-term borrowings and secured long-term financings based on applicable interest rates as of June 2009. Includes stated coupons, if any, on structured notes.
 
(6) Represents estimated undiscounted payments related to future benefits and unpaid claims arising from policies associated with our insurance activities, excluding separate accounts and estimated recoveries under reinsurance contracts.
 
 
As of June 2009, our unsecured long-term borrowings were $191.24 billion, with maturities extending to 2043, and consisted principally of senior borrowings. See Note 7 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our unsecured long-term borrowings.
 
As of June 2009, our future minimum rental payments, net of minimum sublease rentals, under noncancelable leases were $3.43 billion. These lease commitments, principally for office space, expire on various dates through 2069. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation provisions for increases in real estate taxes and other charges. See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our leases.


119


Table of Contents

Our occupancy expenses include costs associated with office space held in excess of our current requirements. This excess space, the cost of which is charged to earnings as incurred, is being held for potential growth or to replace currently occupied space that we may exit in the future. We regularly evaluate our current and future space capacity in relation to current and projected staffing levels. During the three and six months ended June 2009, we incurred exit costs of $35 million and $51 million, respectively, related to our office space (included in “Occupancy” and “Depreciation and Amortization” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings). We may incur exit costs in the future to the extent we (i) reduce our space capacity or (ii) commit to, or occupy, new properties in the locations in which we operate and, consequently, dispose of existing space that had been held for potential growth. These exit costs may be material to our results of operations in a given period.
 
As of June 2009, included in purchase obligations was $390 million of construction-related obligations. As of June 2009, our construction-related obligations include commitments of $348 million, related to our new headquarters in New York City, which is expected to cost between $2.05 billion and $2.15 billion. We have partially financed this construction project with $1.65 billion of tax-exempt Liberty Bonds.
 
Due to the uncertainty of the timing and amounts that will ultimately be paid, our liability for unrecognized tax benefits has been excluded from the above contractual obligations table.
 
See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for information regarding our commitments, contingencies and guarantees.


120


Table of Contents

 
Market Risk
 
The potential for changes in the market value of our trading and investing positions is referred to as market risk. Such positions result from market-making, proprietary trading, underwriting, specialist and investing activities. Substantially all of our inventory positions are marked-to-market on a daily basis and changes are recorded in net revenues.
 
Categories of market risk include exposures to interest rates, equity prices, currency rates and commodity prices. A description of each market risk category is set forth below:
 
  •  Interest rate risks primarily result from exposures to changes in the level, slope and curvature of the yield curve, the volatility of interest rates, mortgage prepayment speeds and credit spreads.
 
  •  Equity price risks result from exposures to changes in prices and volatilities of individual equities, equity baskets and equity indices.
 
  •  Currency rate risks result from exposures to changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of currency rates.
 
  •  Commodity price risks result from exposures to changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of commodities, such as electricity, natural gas, crude oil, petroleum products, and precious and base metals.
 
We seek to manage these risks by diversifying exposures, controlling position sizes and establishing economic hedges in related securities or derivatives. For example, we may seek to hedge a portfolio of common stocks by taking an offsetting position in a related equity-index futures contract. The ability to manage an exposure may, however, be limited by adverse changes in the liquidity of the security or the related hedge instrument and in the correlation of price movements between the security and related hedge instrument.
 
In addition to applying business judgment, senior management uses a number of quantitative tools to manage our exposure to market risk for “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. These tools include:
 
  •  risk limits based on a summary measure of market risk exposure referred to as VaR;
 
  •  scenario analyses, stress tests and other analytical tools that measure the potential effects on our trading net revenues of various market events, including, but not limited to, a large widening of credit spreads, a substantial decline in equity markets and significant moves in selected emerging markets; and
 
  •  inventory position limits for selected business units.
 
VaR
 
VaR is the potential loss in value of trading positions due to adverse market movements over a defined time horizon with a specified confidence level.
 
For the VaR numbers reported below, a one-day time horizon and a 95% confidence level were used. This means that there is a 1 in 20 chance that daily trading net revenues will fall below the expected daily trading net revenues by an amount at least as large as the reported VaR. Thus, shortfalls from expected trading net revenues on a single trading day greater than the reported VaR would be anticipated to occur, on average, about once a month. Shortfalls on a single day can exceed reported VaR by significant amounts. Shortfalls can also occur more frequently or accumulate over a longer time horizon such as a number of consecutive trading days.


121


Table of Contents

The modeling of the risk characteristics of our trading positions involves a number of assumptions and approximations. While we believe that these assumptions and approximations are reasonable, there is no standard methodology for estimating VaR, and different assumptions and/or approximations could produce materially different VaR estimates.
 
We use historical data to estimate our VaR and, to better reflect current asset volatilities, we generally weight historical data to give greater importance to more recent observations. Given its reliance on historical data, VaR is most effective in estimating risk exposures in markets in which there are no sudden fundamental changes or shifts in market conditions. An inherent limitation of VaR is that the distribution of past changes in market risk factors may not produce accurate predictions of future market risk. Different VaR methodologies and distributional assumptions could produce a materially different VaR. Moreover, VaR calculated for a one-day time horizon does not fully capture the market risk of positions that cannot be liquidated or offset with hedges within one day.
 
The following tables set forth the daily VaR:
 
Average Daily VaR (1)
(in millions)
 
                                 
    Average for the
    Three Months Ended   Six Months Ended
    June
  May
  June
  May
Risk Categories
  2009   2008   2009   2008
Interest rates
  $ 205     $ 144     $ 211     $ 125  
Equity prices
    60       79       49       84  
Currency rates
    39       32       38       31  
Commodity prices
    40       48       40       43  
Diversification effect (2)
    (99 )     (119 )     (95 )     (112 )
                                 
Total
  $ 245     $ 184     $ 243     $ 171  
                                 
 
 
(1) Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictions and/or illiquidity). See “— Other Market Risk Measures” below.
 
(2) Equals the difference between total VaR and the sum of the VaRs for the four risk categories. This effect arises because the four market risk categories are not perfectly correlated.
 
 
Our average daily VaR increased to $245 million for the second quarter of 2009 from $184 million for the second quarter of 2008, principally due to an increase in the interest rates category. The increase in interest rates was primarily due to higher market volatility and wider credit spreads.
 
VaR excludes the impact of changes in counterparty and our own credit spreads on derivatives as well as changes in our own credit spreads on unsecured borrowings for which the fair value option was elected. The estimated sensitivity of our net revenues to a one basis point increase in credit spreads (counterparty and our own) on derivatives was less than a $1 million loss as of June 2009. In addition, the estimated sensitivity of our net revenues to a one basis point increase in our own credit spreads on unsecured borrowings for which the fair value option was elected was a $7 million gain (including hedges) as of June 2009.


122


Table of Contents

Daily VaR (1)
(in millions)
 
                                 
    As of   Three Months Ended
    June
  March
  June 2009
Risk Categories
  2009   2009   High   Low
Interest rates
  $ 176     $ 242     $ 242     $ 175  
Equity prices
    72       40       108       33  
Currency rates
    31       43       58       21  
Commodity prices
    29       48       59       28  
Diversification effect (2)
    (87 )     (107 )                
                                 
Total
  $ 221     $ 266     $ 270     $ 212  
                                 
 
 
(1) Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictions and/or illiquidity). See “— Other Market Risk Measures” below.
 
(2) Equals the difference between total VaR and the sum of the VaRs for the four risk categories. This effect arises because the four market risk categories are not perfectly correlated.
 
 
Our daily VaR decreased to $221 million as of June 2009 from $266 million as of March 2009, primarily due to a decrease in the interest rates category, partially offset by an increase in the equity prices category. The decrease in interest rates was principally due to lower levels of volatility and reduced rate exposures. The increase in equity prices was principally driven by increased equity exposures.
 
The following chart presents our daily VaR during the last four quarters and the month of December 2008:
 
Daily VaR
($ in millions)
 


123


Table of Contents

Trading Net Revenues Distribution
 
The following chart sets forth the frequency distribution of our daily trading net revenues for substantially all inventory positions included in VaR for the quarter ended June 2009:
 
Daily Trading Net Revenues
($ in millions)
 
 
 
As part of our overall risk control process, daily trading net revenues are compared with VaR calculated as of the end of the prior business day. Trading losses incurred on a single day did not exceed our 95% one-day VaR during the second quarter of 2009.
 
Other Market Risk Measures
 
Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictions and/or illiquidity). The market risk related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, excluding interests held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs, is measured by estimating the potential reduction in net revenues associated with a 10% decline in the ICBC ordinary share price. The market risk related to the remaining positions is measured by estimating the potential reduction in net revenues associated with a 10% decline in asset values.
 
The sensitivity analyses for equity and debt positions in our trading portfolio and equity, debt (primarily mezzanine instruments) and real estate positions in our non-trading portfolio are measured by the impact of a decline in the asset values (including the impact of leverage in the underlying investments for real estate positions in our non-trading portfolio) of such positions. The fair value of the underlying positions may be impacted by factors such as transactions in similar instruments, completed or pending third-party transactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.


124


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth market risk for positions not included in VaR. These measures do not reflect diversification benefits across asset categories and, given the differing likelihood of the potential declines in asset categories, these measures have not been aggregated:
 
                     
        10% Sensitivity
        Amount as of
Asset Categories
 
10% Sensitivity Measure
 
June 2009
 
March 2009
        (in millions)
 
Trading Risk (1)
                   
Equity (2)
  Underlying asset value   $ 617     $ 667  
Debt (3)
  Underlying asset value     523       521  
                     
Non-trading Risk
                   
ICBC
  ICBC ordinary share price     217       212  
Other Equity (4)
  Underlying asset value     987       982  
Debt (5)
  Underlying asset value     774       689  
Real Estate (6)
  Underlying asset value     828       942  
 
 
(1) In addition to the positions in these portfolios, which are accounted for at fair value, we make investments accounted for under the equity method and we also make direct investments in real estate, both of which are included in “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. Direct investments in real estate are accounted for at cost less accumulated depreciation. See Note 12 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for information on “Other assets.”
 
(2) Relates to private and restricted public equity securities held within the FICC and Equities components of our Trading and Principal Investments segment.
 
(3) Primarily relates to acquired portfolios of distressed loans (primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral), loans backed by commercial real estate, and corporate debt held within the FICC component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment.
 
(4) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in corporate equities.
 
(5) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in corporate mezzanine debt instruments.
 
(6) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in real estate. Such funds typically employ leverage as part of the investment strategy. This sensitivity measure is based on our percentage ownership of the underlying asset values in the funds and unfunded commitments to the funds.
 
 
During the second quarter of 2009, the decrease in our 10% sensitivity measure for equity in our trading portfolio was due to dispositions and a decrease in the fair value of the portfolio. The increase in our 10% sensitivity measure for debt positions in our non-trading portfolio was due to new investment activity and an increase in the fair value of the portfolio. The decrease in our 10% sensitivity measure for real estate positions in our non-trading portfolio was due to a decrease in the fair value of the portfolio.
 
In addition to the positions included in VaR and the other risk measures described above, as of June 2009, we held approximately $13.71 billion of financial instruments in our bank and insurance subsidiaries, primarily consisting of $8.29 billion of money market instruments, $1.37 billion of government and U.S. federal agency obligations, $2.51 billion of corporate debt securities and other debt obligations, and $1.19 billion of mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities. As of November 2008, we held approximately $10.39 billion of financial instruments in our bank and insurance subsidiaries, primarily consisting of $2.86 billion of money market instruments, $3.08 billion of government and U.S. federal agency obligations, $2.87 billion of corporate debt securities and other debt obligations, and $1.22 billion of mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities. In addition, as of June 2009 and November 2008, we held commitments and loans under the William Street credit extension program. See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our William Street credit extension program.


125


Table of Contents

 
Credit Risk
 
Credit risk represents the loss that we would incur if a counterparty or an issuer of securities or other instruments we hold fails to perform under its contractual obligations to us, or upon a deterioration in the credit quality of third parties whose securities or other instruments, including OTC derivatives, we hold. Our exposure to credit risk principally arises through our trading, investing and financing activities. To reduce our credit exposures, we seek to enter into netting agreements with counterparties that permit us to offset receivables and payables with such counterparties. In addition, we attempt to further reduce credit risk with certain counterparties by (i) entering into agreements that enable us to obtain collateral from a counterparty on an upfront or contingent basis, (ii) seeking third-party guarantees of the counterparty’s obligations, and/or (iii) transferring our credit risk to third parties using credit derivatives and/or other structures and techniques.
 
To measure and manage our credit exposures, we use a variety of tools, including credit limits referenced to both current exposure and potential exposure. Potential exposure is an estimate of exposure, within a specified confidence level, that could be outstanding over the life of a transaction based on market movements. In addition, as part of our market risk management process, for positions measured by changes in credit spreads, we use VaR and other sensitivity measures. To supplement our primary credit exposure measures, we also use scenario analyses, such as credit spread widening scenarios, stress tests and other quantitative tools.
 
Our global credit management systems monitor credit exposure to individual counterparties and on an aggregate basis to counterparties and their affiliates. These systems also provide management, including the Firmwide Risk and Credit Policy Committees, with information regarding credit risk by product, industry sector, country and region.
 
While our activities expose us to many different industries and counterparties, we routinely execute a high volume of transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks and investment funds, resulting in significant credit concentration with respect to this industry. In the ordinary course of business, we may also be subject to a concentration of credit risk to a particular counterparty, borrower or issuer.
 
As of June 2009 and November 2008, we held $98.43 billion (11% of total assets) and $53.98 billion (6% of total assets), respectively, of U.S. government and federal agency obligations included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. As of June 2009 and November 2008, we held $44.52 billion (5% of total assets) and $21.13 billion (2% of total assets), respectively, of other sovereign obligations, principally consisting of securities issued by the governments of Japan and the United Kingdom. In addition, as of June 2009 and November 2008, $129.35 billion and $126.27 billion of our securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed (including those in “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes”), respectively, were collateralized by U.S. government and federal agency obligations. As of June 2009 and November 2008, $62.90 billion and $65.37 billion of our securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed, respectively, were collateralized by other sovereign obligations, principally consisting of securities issued by the governments of Germany and Japan. As of June 2009 and November 2008, we did not have credit exposure to any other counterparty that exceeded 2% of our total assets.


126


Table of Contents

 
Derivatives
 
Derivative contracts are instruments, such as futures, forwards, swaps or option contracts, that derive their value from underlying assets, indices, reference rates or a combination of these factors. Derivative instruments may be privately negotiated contracts, which are often referred to as OTC derivatives, or they may be listed and traded on an exchange.
 
Substantially all of our derivative transactions are entered into to facilitate client transactions, to take proprietary positions or as a means of risk management. In addition to derivative transactions entered into for trading purposes, we enter into derivative contracts to manage currency exposure on our net investment in non-U.S. operations and to manage the interest rate and currency exposure on our long-term borrowings and certain short-term borrowings.
 
Derivatives are used in many of our businesses, and we believe that the associated market risk can only be understood relative to all of the underlying assets or risks being hedged, or as part of a broader trading strategy. Accordingly, the market risk of derivative positions is managed together with our nonderivative positions.
 
The fair value of our derivative contracts is reflected net of cash paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements and is reported on a net-by-counterparty basis in our condensed consolidated statements of financial condition when we believe a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement. For an OTC derivative, our credit exposure is directly with our counterparty and continues until the maturity or termination of such contract.


127


Table of Contents

The following tables set forth the fair values of our OTC derivative assets and liabilities by product type and by tenor. Tenor is based on expected duration for mortgage-related credit derivatives and on remaining contractual maturity for other derivatives.
 
OTC Derivatives
(in millions)
 
                                         
Assets   As of June 2009
    0 - 12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
   
Product Type
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
Interest rates
  $ 10,628     $ 42,755     $ 27,262     $ 38,214     $ 118,859  
Credit derivatives
    10,284       26,613       15,499       8,937       61,333  
Currencies
    13,537       10,504       6,034       4,518       34,593  
Commodities
    10,260       9,613       603       502       20,978  
Equities
    17,674       6,975       2,975       1,270       28,894  
Netting across product types (1)
    (4,137 )     (8,916 )     (3,319 )     (2,553 )     (18,925 )
                                         
Subtotal
  $ 58,246  (4)   $ 87,544     $ 49,054     $ 50,888     $ 245,732  
                                         
Cross maturity netting (2)
                                    (27,080 )
Cash collateral netting (3)
                                    (133,335 )
                                         
Total
                                  $ 85,317  
                                         
                                         
                                         
Liabilities                    
    0 - 12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
   
Product Type
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Interest rates
  $ 8,869     $ 12,222     $ 10,259     $ 13,351     $ 44,701  
Credit derivatives
    4,559       4,858       8,561       4,310       22,288  
Currencies
    11,467       6,544       3,427       2,236       23,674  
Commodities
    11,089       6,180       1,047       1,169       19,485  
Equities
    9,605       2,105       2,435       599       14,744  
Netting across product types (1)
    (4,137 )     (8,916 )     (3,319 )     (2,553 )     (18,925 )
                                         
Subtotal
  $ 41,452  (4)   $ 22,993     $ 22,410     $ 19,112     $ 105,967  
                                         
Cross maturity netting (2)
                                    (27,080 )
Cash collateral netting (3)
                                    (16,309 )
                                         
Total
                                  $ 62,578  
                                         
 
 
(1) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across product types within a maturity category, pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(2) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories, pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(3) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(4) Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets and liabilities, maturing within six months, of $37.29 billion and $27.44 billion, respectively.


128


Table of Contents

OTC Derivatives
(in millions)
 
                                         
Assets   As of November 2008
    0 - 12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
   
Product Type
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Interest rates
  $ 9,757     $ 39,806     $ 36,229     $ 48,508     $ 134,300  
Credit derivatives
    18,608       29,625       27,151       11,682       87,066  
Currencies
    28,056       12,191       5,980       4,137       50,364  
Commodities
    13,660       12,500       1,175       1,898       29,233  
Equities
    17,046       3,945       4,279       2,475       27,745  
Netting across product types (1)
    (5,390 )     (8,124 )     (4,287 )     (2,779 )     (20,580 )
                                         
Subtotal
  $ 81,737  (4)   $ 89,943     $ 70,527     $ 65,921     $ 308,128  
                                         
Cross maturity netting (2)
                                    (46,795 )
Cash collateral netting (3)
                                    (137,160 )
                                         
Total
                                  $ 124,173  
                                         
                                         
                                         
Liabilities                    
    0 - 12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
   
Product Type
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Interest rates
  $ 6,293     $ 14,201     $ 17,671     $ 28,363     $ 66,528  
Credit derivatives
    7,991       23,316       13,380       3,981       48,668  
Currencies
    29,130       13,755       4,109       2,051       49,045  
Commodities
    12,685       10,391       1,575       827       25,478  
Equities
    12,391       5,065       2,654       903       21,013  
Netting across product types (1)
    (5,390 )     (8,124 )     (4,287 )     (2,779 )     (20,580 )
                                         
Subtotal
  $ 63,100  (4)   $ 58,604     $ 35,102     $ 33,346     $ 190,152  
                                         
Cross maturity netting (2)
                                    (46,795 )
Cash collateral netting (3)
                                    (34,009 )
                                         
Total
                                  $ 109,348  
                                         
 
 
(1) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across product types within a maturity category, pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(2) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories, pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(3) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(4) Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets and liabilities, maturing within six months, of $56.64 billion and $48.56 billion, respectively.
 
 
In the tables above, for option contracts that require settlement by delivery of an underlying derivative instrument, the tenor is generally classified based upon the maturity date of the underlying derivative instrument. In those instances where the underlying instrument does not have a maturity date or either counterparty has the right to settle in cash, the tenor is generally based upon the option expiration date.


129


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the distribution, by credit rating, of our exposure with respect to OTC derivatives by tenor, both before and after consideration of the effect of collateral and netting agreements. Tenor is based on expected duration for mortgage-related credit derivatives and on remaining contractual maturity for other derivatives. The categories shown reflect our internally determined public rating agency equivalents:
 
OTC Derivative Credit Exposure
(in millions)
 
                                                                 
    As of June 2009
                                Exposure
Credit Rating
  0 - 12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
              Net of
Equivalent
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Netting (2)
 
Exposure
 
Collateral
 
AAA/Aaa
  $ 2,743     $ 4,524     $ 4,623     $ 3,209     $ 15,099     $ (6,221 )   $ 8,878     $ 8,520  
AA/Aa2
    6,989       20,669       9,252       9,252       46,162       (32,641 )     13,521       9,759  
A/A2
    36,715       39,178       28,307       28,760       132,960       (103,597 )     29,363       25,539  
BBB/Baa2
    5,091       10,211       3,435       7,238       25,975       (11,908 )     14,067       8,492  
BB/Ba2 or lower
    5,849       11,576       2,814       1,983       22,222       (5,965 )     16,257       10,160  
Unrated
    859       1,386       623       446       3,314       (83 )     3,231       2,808  
                                                                 
Total
  $ 58,246  (1)   $ 87,544     $ 49,054     $ 50,888     $ 245,732     $ (160,415 )   $ 85,317     $ 65,278  
                                                                 
                                                                 
                                                                 
    As of November 2008
                                Exposure
Credit Rating
  0 - 12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
              Net of
Equivalent
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Netting (2)
 
Exposure
 
Collateral
 
AAA/Aaa
  $ 5,519     $ 3,871     $ 5,853     $ 4,250     $ 19,493     $ (6,093 )   $ 13,400     $ 12,312  
AA/Aa2
    26,835       30,532       33,479       18,980       109,826       (76,119 )     33,707       29,435  
A/A2
    25,416       27,263       17,009       24,427       94,115       (59,903 )     34,212       28,614  
BBB/Baa2
    11,324       17,156       8,684       14,311       51,475       (29,229 )     22,246       16,211  
BB/Ba2 or lower
    11,835       10,228       4,586       3,738       30,387       (12,600 )     17,787       11,204  
Unrated
    808       893       916       215       2,832       (11 )     2,821       1,550  
                                                                 
Total
  $ 81,737  (1)   $ 89,943     $ 70,527     $ 65,921     $ 308,128     $ (183,955 )   $ 124,173     $ 99,326  
                                                                 
 
 
(1)  Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets, maturing within six months, of $37.29 billion and $56.64 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively.
 
(2)  Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories and the netting of cash collateral received, pursuant to credit support agreements. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same maturity category are netted within such maturity category, where appropriate.
 
 
Derivative transactions may also involve legal risks including the risk that they are not authorized or appropriate for a counterparty, that documentation has not been properly executed or that executed agreements may not be enforceable against the counterparty. We attempt to minimize these risks by obtaining advice of counsel on the enforceability of agreements as well as on the authority of a counterparty to effect the derivative transaction. In addition, certain derivative transactions (e.g., credit derivative contracts) involve the risk that we may have difficulty obtaining, or be unable to obtain, the underlying security or obligation in order to satisfy any physical settlement requirement.


130


Table of Contents

 
Liquidity and Funding Risk
 
Liquidity is of critical importance to companies in the financial services sector. Most failures of financial institutions have occurred in large part due to insufficient liquidity resulting from adverse circumstances. Accordingly, Goldman Sachs has in place a comprehensive set of liquidity and funding policies that are intended to maintain significant flexibility to address both Goldman Sachs-specific and broader industry or market liquidity events. Our principal objective is to be able to fund Goldman Sachs and to enable our core businesses to continue to generate revenues, even under adverse circumstances.
 
We have implemented a number of policies according to the following liquidity risk management framework:
 
  •  Excess Liquidity — We maintain substantial excess liquidity to meet a broad range of potential cash outflows in a stressed environment, including financing obligations.
 
  •  Asset-Liability Management — We seek to maintain secured and unsecured funding sources that are sufficiently long-term in order to withstand a prolonged or severe liquidity-stressed environment without having to rely on asset sales.
 
  •  Conservative Liability Structure — We seek to access funding across a diverse range of markets, products and counterparties, emphasize less credit-sensitive sources of funding and conservatively manage the distribution of funding across our entity structure.
 
  •  Crisis Planning — We base our liquidity and funding management on stress-scenario planning and maintain a crisis plan detailing our response to a liquidity-threatening event.
 
Excess Liquidity
 
Our most important liquidity policy is to pre-fund what we estimate will be our potential cash needs during a liquidity crisis and hold such excess liquidity in the form of unencumbered, highly liquid securities that may be sold or pledged to provide same-day liquidity. This “Global Core Excess” is intended to allow us to meet immediate obligations without needing to sell other assets or depend on additional funding from credit-sensitive markets. We believe that this pool of excess liquidity provides us with a resilient source of funds and gives us significant flexibility in managing through a difficult funding environment. Our Global Core Excess reflects the following principles:
 
  •  The first days or weeks of a liquidity crisis are the most critical to a company’s survival.
 
  •  Focus must be maintained on all potential cash and collateral outflows, not just disruptions to financing flows. Our businesses are diverse, and our cash needs are driven by many factors, including market movements, collateral requirements and client commitments, all of which can change dramatically in a difficult funding environment.
 
  •  During a liquidity crisis, credit-sensitive funding, including unsecured debt and some types of secured financing agreements, may be unavailable, and the terms or availability of other types of secured financing may change.
 
  •  As a result of our policy to pre-fund liquidity that we estimate may be needed in a crisis, we hold more unencumbered securities and have larger unsecured debt balances than our businesses would otherwise require. We believe that our liquidity is stronger with greater balances of highly liquid unencumbered securities, even though it increases our unsecured liabilities and our funding costs.


131


Table of Contents

 
The size of our Global Core Excess is based on an internal liquidity model together with a qualitative assessment of the condition of the financial markets and of Goldman Sachs. Our liquidity model identifies and estimates contractual and contingent cash and collateral outflows over a short-term horizon in a liquidity crisis, including, but not limited to:
 
  •  upcoming maturities of unsecured debt and letters of credit;
 
  •  potential buybacks of a portion of our outstanding negotiable unsecured debt and potential withdrawals of client deposits;
 
  •  adverse changes in the terms or availability of secured funding;
 
  •  derivatives and other margin and collateral outflows, including those due to market moves;
 
  •  potential liquidity outflows associated with our prime brokerage business;
 
  •  additional collateral that could be called in the event of a two-notch downgrade in our credit ratings;
 
  •  draws on our unfunded commitments not supported by William Street Funding Corporation (1); and
 
  •  upcoming cash outflows, such as tax and other large payments.
 
The following table sets forth the average loan value (the estimated amount of cash that would be advanced by counterparties against these securities), as well as overnight cash deposits, of our Global Core Excess:
 
                 
    Three Months
  Year Ended
    Ended June   November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
U.S. dollar-denominated
  $ 128,434     $ 78,048  
Non-U.S. dollar-denominated
    42,514       18,677  
                 
Total Global Core Excess
  $ 170,948     $ 96,725  
                 
 
 
The U.S. dollar-denominated excess is comprised of only unencumbered U.S. government securities, U.S. agency securities and highly liquid U.S. agency mortgage-backed securities, all of which are eligible as collateral in Federal Reserve open market operations, as well as overnight cash deposits. Our non-U.S. dollar-denominated excess is comprised of only unencumbered French, German, United Kingdom and Japanese government bonds and overnight cash deposits in highly liquid currencies. We strictly limit our Global Core Excess to this narrowly defined list of securities and cash because we believe they are highly liquid, even in a difficult funding environment. We do not believe that other potential sources of excess liquidity, such as lower-quality unencumbered securities or committed credit facilities, are as reliable in a liquidity crisis.
 
We maintain our Global Core Excess to enable us to meet current and potential liquidity requirements of our parent company, Group Inc., and all of its subsidiaries. The amount of our Global Core Excess is driven by our assessment of potential cash and collateral outflows, regulatory obligations and the currency and timing requirements of our global business model. In addition, we recognize that our Global Core Excess held in a regulated entity may not be available to our parent company or other subsidiaries and therefore may only be available to meet the potential liquidity requirements of that entity.
 
 
(1)   The Global Core Excess excludes liquid assets of $4.56 billion held separately by William Street Funding Corporation. See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding the William Street credit extension program.
     


132


Table of Contents

In addition to our Global Core Excess, we have a significant amount of other unencumbered securities as a result of our business activities. These assets, which are located in the U.S., Europe and Asia, include other government bonds, high-grade money market securities, corporate bonds and marginable equities. We do not include these securities in our Global Core Excess.
 
We maintain our Global Core Excess and other unencumbered assets in an amount that, if pledged or sold, would provide the funds necessary to replace at least 110% of our unsecured obligations that are scheduled to mature (or where holders have the option to redeem) within the next 12 months. We assume conservative loan values that are based on stress-scenario borrowing capacity and we regularly review these assumptions asset class by asset class. The estimated aggregate loan value of our Global Core Excess, as well as overnight cash deposits, and our other unencumbered assets averaged $220.77 billion and $163.41 billion for the three months ended June 2009 and year ended November 2008, respectively.
 
Asset-Liability Management
 
We seek to maintain a highly liquid balance sheet and substantially all of our inventory is marked-to-market daily. We utilize aged inventory limits for certain financial instruments as a disincentive to our businesses to hold inventory over longer periods of time. We believe that these limits provide a complementary mechanism for ensuring appropriate balance sheet liquidity in addition to our standard position limits. Although our balance sheet fluctuates due to client activity, market conventions and periodic market opportunities in certain of our businesses, our total assets and adjusted assets at financial statement dates are typically not materially different from those occurring within our reporting periods.
 
We seek to manage the maturity profile of our secured and unsecured funding base such that we should be able to liquidate our assets prior to our liabilities coming due, even in times of prolonged or severe liquidity stress. We do not rely on immediate sales of assets (other than our Global Core Excess) to maintain liquidity in a distressed environment, although we recognize orderly asset sales may be prudent or necessary in a severe or persistent liquidity crisis.
 
In order to avoid reliance on asset sales, our goal is to ensure that we have sufficient total capital (unsecured long-term borrowings plus total shareholders’ equity) to fund our balance sheet for at least one year. The target amount of our total capital is based on an internal liquidity model which incorporates, among other things, the following long-term financing requirements:
 
  •  the portion of trading assets that we believe could not be funded on a secured basis in periods of market stress, assuming conservative loan values;
 
  •  goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, property, leasehold improvements and equipment, and other illiquid assets;
 
  •  derivative and other margin and collateral requirements;
 
  •  anticipated draws on our unfunded loan commitments; and
 
  •  capital or other forms of financing in our regulated subsidiaries that are in excess of their long-term financing requirements. See “— Conservative Liability Structure” below for a further discussion of how we fund our subsidiaries.


133


Table of Contents

 
Certain financial instruments may be more difficult to fund on a secured basis during times of market stress. Accordingly, we generally hold higher levels of total capital for these assets than more liquid types of financial instruments. The following table sets forth our aggregate holdings in these categories of financial instruments:
 
                 
    As of
    June
  November
    2009   2008
    (in millions)
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
  $ 13,730     $ 22,393  
Bank loans and bridge loans (1)
    18,349       21,839  
Emerging market debt securities
    1,639       2,827  
High-yield and other debt obligations
    10,708       9,998  
Private equity and real estate fund investments (2)
    14,380       18,171  
Emerging market equity securities
    4,554       2,665  
ICBC ordinary shares (3)
    6,269       5,496  
SMFG convertible preferred stock
    1,330       1,135  
Other restricted public equity securities
    237       568  
Other investments in funds (4)
    2,809       2,714  
 
 
(1) Includes funded commitments and inventory held in connection with our origination and secondary trading activities.
 
(2) Includes interests in our merchant banking funds. Such amounts exclude assets related to consolidated investment funds of $899 million and $1.16 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, for which Goldman Sachs does not bear economic exposure.
 
(3) Includes interests of $3.96 billion and $3.48 billion as of June 2009 and November 2008, respectively, held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs.
 
(4) Includes interests in other investment funds that we manage.
 
 
We focus on funding these assets with long contractual maturities to reduce refinancing risk in periods of market stress.
 
See Note 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding the financial instruments we hold.
 
Conservative Liability Structure
 
We seek to structure our liabilities conservatively to reduce refinancing risk and the risk that we may be required to redeem or repurchase certain of our borrowings prior to their contractual maturity.
 
We fund a substantial portion of our inventory on a secured basis, which we believe provides Goldman Sachs with a more stable source of liquidity than unsecured financing, as it is less sensitive to changes in our credit due to the underlying collateral. However, we recognize that the terms or availability of secured funding, particularly overnight funding, can deteriorate rapidly in a difficult environment. To help mitigate this risk, we raise the majority of our funding for durations longer than overnight. We seek longer terms for secured funding collateralized by lower-quality assets, as we believe these funding transactions may pose greater refinancing risk. The weighted average life of our secured funding, excluding funding collateralized by highly liquid securities, such as U.S., French, German, United Kingdom and Japanese government bonds, and U.S. agency securities, exceeded 100 days as of June 2009.


134


Table of Contents

Our liquidity also depends, to an important degree, on the stability of our short-term unsecured financing base. Accordingly, we prefer the use of promissory notes (in which Goldman Sachs does not make a market) over commercial paper, which we may repurchase prior to maturity through the ordinary course of business as a market maker. As of June 2009, our unsecured short-term borrowings, including the current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings, were $35.17 billion. See Note 6 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for further information regarding our unsecured short-term borrowings.
 
We issue long-term borrowings as a source of total capital in order to meet our long-term financing requirements. The following table sets forth our quarterly unsecured long-term borrowings maturity profile through the second quarter of 2015:
 
Unsecured Long-Term Borrowings Maturity Profile
($ in millions)
 
 
 
The weighted average maturity of our unsecured long-term borrowings as of June 2009 was approximately seven years. To mitigate refinancing risk, we seek to limit the principal amount of debt maturing on any one day or during any week or year. We swap a substantial portion of our long-term borrowings into short-term floating rate obligations in order to minimize our exposure to interest rates.
 
We issue substantially all of our unsecured debt without provisions that would, based solely upon an adverse change in our credit ratings, financial ratios, earnings, cash flows or stock price, trigger a requirement for an early payment, collateral support, change in terms, acceleration of maturity or the creation of an additional financial obligation.


135


Table of Contents

As of June 2009, our bank depository institution subsidiaries had $41.46 billion in customer deposits, including $28.45 billion of deposits from bank sweep programs and $13.01 billion of certificates of deposit and other time deposits with a weighted average maturity of three years. Since September 2008, GS Bank USA has had access to funding through the Federal Reserve Bank discount window. While we do not rely on funding through the Federal Reserve Bank discount window in our liquidity modeling and stress testing, we maintain policies and procedures necessary to access this funding.
 
We seek to maintain broad and diversified funding sources globally for both secured and unsecured funding. We make extensive use of the repurchase agreement and securities lending markets, as well as other secured funding markets. In addition, we issue debt through syndicated U.S. registered offerings, U.S. registered and 144A medium-term note programs, offshore medium-term note offerings and other bond offerings, U.S. and non-U.S. commercial paper and promissory note issuances and other methods. We also arrange for letters of credit to be issued on our behalf.
 
We seek to distribute our funding products through our own sales force to a large, diverse global creditor base and we believe that our relationships with our creditors are critical to our liquidity. Our creditors include banks, governments, securities lenders, pension funds, insurance companies, mutual funds and individuals. We access funding in a variety of markets in the Americas, Europe and Asia. We have imposed various internal guidelines on creditor concentration, including the amount of our commercial paper and promissory notes that can be owned and letters of credit that can be issued by any single creditor or group of creditors.
 
As a bank holding company, the firm has access to certain programs and facilities established on a temporary basis by a number of U.S. regulatory agencies, including the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (TLGP). See “Liquidity and Funding Risk” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 2008 for a discussion of these programs. Under the TLGP, we are able to have outstanding approximately $35 billion of debt that is issued prior to October 31, 2009 guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC). As of June 2009, we had outstanding $25.14 billion of senior unsecured debt (comprised of $4.39 billion of short-term and $20.75 billion of long-term) under the TLGP.
 
See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of factors that could impair our ability to access the capital markets.
 
Subsidiary Funding Policies.  The majority of our unsecured funding is raised by our parent company, Group Inc. The parent company then lends the necessary funds to its subsidiaries, some of which are regulated, to meet their asset financing and capital requirements. In addition, the parent company provides its regulated subsidiaries with the necessary capital to meet their regulatory requirements. The benefits of this approach to subsidiary funding include enhanced control and greater flexibility to meet the funding requirements of our subsidiaries. Funding is also raised at the subsidiary level through secured funding and deposits.
 
Our intercompany funding policies are predicated on an assumption that, unless legally provided for, funds or securities are not freely available from a subsidiary to its parent company or other subsidiaries. In particular, many of our subsidiaries are subject to laws that authorize regulatory bodies to block or limit the flow of funds from those subsidiaries to Group Inc. Regulatory action of that kind could impede access to funds that Group Inc. needs to make payments on obligations, including debt obligations. As such, we assume that capital or other financing provided to our regulated subsidiaries is not available to our parent company or other subsidiaries until the maturity of such financing. In addition, we recognize that the Global Core Excess held in our regulated entities may not be available to our parent company or other subsidiaries and therefore may only be available to meet the potential liquidity requirements of those entities.


136


Table of Contents

We also manage our liquidity risk by requiring senior and subordinated intercompany loans to have maturities equal to or shorter than the maturities of the aggregate borrowings of the parent company. This policy ensures that the subsidiaries’ obligations to the parent company will generally mature in advance of the parent company’s third-party borrowings. In addition, many of our subsidiaries and affiliates maintain unencumbered assets to cover their unsecured intercompany borrowings (other than subordinated debt) in order to mitigate parent company liquidity risk.
 
Group Inc. has provided substantial amounts of equity and subordinated indebtedness, directly or indirectly, to its regulated subsidiaries. For example, as of June 2009, Group Inc. had $24.75 billion of such equity and subordinated indebtedness invested in GS&Co., its principal U.S. registered broker-dealer; $23.71 billion invested in GSI, a regulated U.K. broker-dealer; $2.53 billion invested in Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P., a U.S. registered broker-dealer; $3.73 billion invested in Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd., a regulated Japanese broker-dealer; and $20.05 billion invested in GS Bank USA, a regulated New York State-chartered bank. Group Inc. also had $90.05 billion of unsubordinated loans and $17.22 billion of collateral provided to these entities as of June 2009, as well as significant amounts of capital invested in and loans to its other regulated subsidiaries.
 
Crisis Planning
 
In order to be prepared for a liquidity event, or a period of market stress, we base our liquidity risk management framework and our resulting funding and liquidity policies on conservative stress-scenario assumptions. Our planning incorporates several market-based and operational stress scenarios. We also periodically conduct liquidity crisis drills to test our lines of communication and backup funding procedures.
 
In addition, we maintain a liquidity crisis plan that specifies an approach for analyzing and responding to a liquidity-threatening event. The plan provides the framework to estimate the likely impact of a liquidity event on Goldman Sachs based on some of the risks identified above and outlines which and to what extent liquidity maintenance activities should be implemented based on the severity of the event.
 
Credit Ratings
 
We rely upon the short-term and long-term debt capital markets to fund a significant portion of our day-to-day operations. The cost and availability of debt financing is influenced by our credit ratings. Credit ratings are important when we are competing in certain markets and when we seek to engage in longer-term transactions, including OTC derivatives. We believe our credit ratings are primarily based on the credit rating agencies’ assessment of our liquidity, market, credit and operational risk management practices, the level and variability of our earnings, our capital base, our franchise, reputation and management, our corporate governance and the external operating environment, including the perceived level of government support. See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of the risks associated with a reduction in our credit ratings.


137


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth our unsecured credit ratings (excluding debt guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP) as of June 2009:
 
                 
    Short-Term Debt   Long-Term Debt   Subordinated Debt   Preferred Stock
Dominion Bond Rating Service Limited
  R-1 (middle)   A (high)   A   BBB
Fitch, Inc. 
  F1+   A+   A   A−
Moody’s Investors Service (1)
  P-1   A1   A2   A3
Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services
  A-1   A   A−   BBB
Rating and Investment Information, Inc. 
  a-1+   AA−   Not Applicable   Not Applicable
 
 
(1)  GS Bank USA has been assigned a Long-Term Issuer rating of Aa3 as well as a rating of Aa3 for Long-Term Bank Deposits and a rating of P-1 for Short-Term Bank Deposits.
 
 
Based on our credit ratings as of June 2009, additional collateral or termination payments pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties of approximately $763 million and $1.93 billion could have been called by counterparties in the event of a one-notch and two-notch reduction, respectively, in our long-term credit ratings. In evaluating our liquidity requirements, we consider additional collateral or termination payments that may be required in the event of a two-notch reduction in our long-term credit ratings, as well as collateral that has not been called by counterparties, but is available to them.
 
Cash Flows
 
As a global financial institution, our cash flows are complex and interrelated and bear little relation to our net earnings and net assets and, consequently, we believe that traditional cash flow analysis is less meaningful in evaluating our liquidity position than the excess liquidity and asset-liability management policies described above. Cash flow analysis may, however, be helpful in highlighting certain macro trends and strategic initiatives in our businesses.
 
Six Months Ended June 2009.  Our cash and cash equivalents increased by $8.37 billion to $22.18 billion at the end of the second quarter of 2009. We generated $16.02 billion in net cash from operating activities. We used net cash of $7.65 billion from investing and financing activities, primarily for net repayments in secured and unsecured short-term borrowings and the repurchase of Series H Preferred Stock, partially offset by an increase in bank deposits and the issuance of common stock.
 
Six Months Ended May 2008.  Our cash and cash equivalents increased by $1.02 billion to $11.31 billion at the end of the second quarter of 2008. We raised $18.68 billion in net cash from financing activities, primarily in unsecured borrowings and bank deposits, partially offset by repayments of secured financings. We used net cash of $17.66 billion in our operating and investing activities, primarily to capitalize on trading and investing opportunities for our clients and ourselves.
 
Recent Accounting Developments
 
See Note 2 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for information regarding Recent Accounting Developments.


138


Table of Contents

 
Cautionary Statement Pursuant to the U.S. Private Securities
Litigation Reform Act of 1995
 
We have included or incorporated by reference in this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, and from time to time our management may make, statements that may constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the safe harbor provisions of the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements are not historical facts but instead represent only our beliefs regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and outside our control. It is possible that our actual results and financial condition may differ, possibly materially, from the anticipated results and financial condition indicated in these forward-looking statements. For a discussion of some of the risks and important factors that could affect our future results and financial condition, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008 and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008.
 
Certain of the information regarding our capital ratios, as calculated in accordance with Basel I, is based on certain market risk measures that are under review by the Federal Reserve Board. This information is subject to change as the calculation of these ratios has not been reviewed with the Federal Reserve Board, and these ratios may be revised in subsequent filings.
 
Statements about our investment banking transaction backlog also may constitute forward-looking statements. Such statements are subject to the risk that the terms of these transactions may be modified or that they may not be completed at all; therefore, the net revenues, if any, that we actually earn from these transactions may differ, possibly materially, from those currently expected. Important factors that could result in a modification of the terms of a transaction or a transaction not being completed include, in the case of underwriting transactions, a decline or continued weakness in general economic conditions, outbreak of hostilities, volatility in the securities markets generally or an adverse development with respect to the issuer of the securities and, in the case of financial advisory transactions, a decline in the securities markets, an inability to obtain adequate financing, an adverse development with respect to a party to the transaction or a failure to obtain a required regulatory approval. For a discussion of other important factors that could adversely affect our investment banking transactions, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008 and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008.
 
Item 3:   Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
 
Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk are set forth under “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Market Risk” in Part I, Item 2 above.
 
Item 4:   Controls and Procedures
 
As of the end of the period covered by this report, an evaluation was carried out by Goldman Sachs’ management, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Exchange Act)). Based upon that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that these disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report. In addition, no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Exchange Act) occurred during our most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.


139


Table of Contents

 
PART II: OTHER INFORMATION
 
Item 1:   Legal Proceedings
 
The following supplements and amends our discussion set forth under Item 3 “Legal Proceedings” in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008, as updated by our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 27, 2009.
 
Research Independence Matters
 
In the class action relating to coverage of RSL Communications, Inc., on April 30, 2009, plaintiffs renewed their motion seeking class certification.
 
Adelphia Communications Fraudulent Conveyance Litigation
 
By a decision dated May 4, 2009, the district court denied GS&Co.’s motion to dismiss. GS&Co. moved for reconsideration, and by a decision dated June 15, 2009, the district court granted the motion insofar as requiring plaintiff to amend its complaint to specify the source of the margin payments to GS&Co. By a decision dated July 30, 2009, the district court held that the sufficiency of the amended claim would be determined at the summary judgment stage.
 
Executive Compensation Matters
 
In the action filed in New York state court, Group Inc. removed the action to federal court, and it has been transferred on consent to the U.S. District Court for the Eastern District of New York, where defendants moved to dismiss on July 8, 2009. On July 10, 2009, plaintiff moved to remand the action to state court.
 
Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates have received inquiries from various governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations regarding the firm’s compensation processes. The firm is cooperating with the requests.
 
The Board has received several demand letters from shareholders relating to compensation matters, including demands that the Board investigate compensation awards over recent years, take steps to recoup alleged excessive compensation, and adopt certain reforms. The Board is considering the demand letters.
 
Mortgage-Related Matters
 
On May 11, 2009, the Massachusetts Attorney General announced that it had entered into an agreement with GS&Co. (on behalf of itself and certain affiliates) in order to conclude and resolve all issues arising from the Attorney General’s investigation of certain subprime matters. In connection with the settlement, GS&Co. agreed, among other things, to pay $10 million to Massachusetts and offer to provide certain relief to Massachusetts homeowners whose mortgages are owned by GS&Co. or its affiliates.
 
In the action brought by the City of Cleveland, the district court granted defendants’ motion to dismiss by a decision dated May 15, 2009. The City appealed on May 18, 2009.
 
In the purported class action relating to various mortgage pass-through and asset-backed certificates issued by various securitization trusts in 2007, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint on May 15, 2009.


140


Table of Contents

Group Inc., GS&Co., Goldman Sachs Mortgage Company and GS Mortgage Securities Corp. are among the defendants in a separate putative class action commenced on February 6, 2009 in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York brought on behalf of purchasers of various mortgage pass-through certificates and asset-backed certificates issued by various securitization trusts in 2006 and underwritten by GS&Co. The other defendants include three current or former Goldman Sachs employees and various rating agencies. The amended complaint generally alleges that the registration statement and prospectus supplements for the certificates violated the federal securities laws. The amended complaint asserts a claim under Section 11 of the Securities Act against all defendants, a claim under Section 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act against Group Inc. and GS&Co. and a related “controlling person” claim under Section 15 of the Securities Act against Group Inc., GS&Co., Goldman Sachs Mortgage Company and the individual defendants, and seeks unspecified compensatory and rescissionary damages.
 
Auction Products Matters
 
In the shareholder derivative actions against Group Inc., its board of directors, and certain senior officers, on May 19, 2009, the district court granted defendants’ motion to dismiss, and on July 20, 2009 denied plaintiffs’ motion for reconsideration.
 
Washington Mutual Securities Litigation
 
By a decision dated May 15, 2009, the district court granted in part and denied in part the underwriter defendants’ motion to dismiss, with leave to replead, and on June 15, 2009, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint. On July 17, 2009, the underwriters moved to dismiss certain aspects of the amended complaint.
 
Britannia Bulk Securities Litigation
 
On June 12, 2009, the underwriter defendants including GS&Co. moved to dismiss.
 
IndyMac Pass-Through Certificates Litigation
 
On May 21, 2009, plaintiffs voluntarily dismissed their California complaint. On May 14, 2009, a new plaintiff filed an action in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York asserting the same substantive claims as in the California action.
 
Montana Power Litigation
 
On July 21, 2009, the parties reached a settlement in principle, subject to, among other things, negotiation of a definitive agreement and court approval.
 
Credit Derivatives
 
Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates have received inquiries from various governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations regarding credit derivative instruments. The firm is cooperating with the requests.
 
Enron Litigation Matters
 
On August 3, 2009, GS&Co. entered into a definitive settlement agreement with plaintiffs in the purported securities class action relating to the exchangeable notes. The settlement remains subject to court approval.


141


Table of Contents

Item 2:   Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds
 
The table below sets forth the information with respect to purchases made by or on behalf of Group Inc. or any “affiliated purchaser” (as defined in Rule 10b-18(a)(3) under the Exchange Act) of our common stock during the three months ended June 26, 2009.
 
                                 
            Total Number of
  Maximum Number
        Average
  Shares Purchased
  of Shares That May
    Total Number
  Price
  as Part of Publicly
  Yet Be Purchased
    of Shares
  Paid per
  Announced Plans
  Under the Plans or
Period
 
Purchased
 
Share
 
or Programs (1)
 
Programs (1)
Month #1
                      60,838,106  
(March 28, 2009 to
April 24, 2009)
                               
Month #2
                      60,838,106  
(April 25, 2009 to
May 29, 2009)
                               
Month #3
                      60,838,106  
(May 30, 2009 to
June 26, 2009)
                               
                                 
Total
                           
                                 
 
 
(1) On March 21, 2000, we announced that our board of directors had approved a repurchase program, pursuant to which up to 15 million shares of our common stock may be repurchased. This repurchase program was increased by an aggregate of 280 million shares by resolutions of our board of directors adopted on June 18, 2001, March 18, 2002, November 20, 2002, January 30, 2004, January 25, 2005, September 16, 2005, September 11, 2006 and December 17, 2007. We use our share repurchase program to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity and to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employee share-based compensation.
 
The repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by our current and projected capital positions (i.e., comparisons of our desired level of capital to our actual level of capital) but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of our common stock, in each case subject to the limit described in the prior paragraph. The total remaining authorization under the repurchase program was 60,838,106 shares as of July 24, 2009; the repurchase program has no set expiration or termination date.


142


Table of Contents

Item 4:   Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders
 
On May 8, 2009, Group Inc. held its Annual Meeting of Shareholders at which the shareholders voted upon (i) the election of Lloyd C. Blankfein, John H. Bryan, Gary D. Cohn, Claes Dahlbäck, Stephen Friedman, William W. George, Rajat K. Gupta, James A. Johnson, Lois D. Juliber, Lakshmi N. Mittal, James J. Schiro and Ruth J. Simmons to the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (the Board) for one-year terms, (ii) the ratification of the appointment of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as Group Inc.’s independent registered public accounting firm for the 2009 fiscal year, (iii) a management-sponsored advisory vote to approve executive compensation, (iv) a shareholder proposal requesting that the Board take the necessary steps to adopt cumulative voting, (v) a shareholder proposal requesting that the Board take the necessary steps to adopt simple majority voting, (vi) a shareholder proposal to amend the by-laws of Group Inc. (By-laws) to provide for a board committee on U.S. economic security and (vii) a shareholder proposal requesting that Group Inc. provide a report relating to its political contributions and expenditures.
 
The shareholders elected all twelve directors, approved the ratification of the appointment of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP as Group Inc.’s independent registered public accounting firm for the 2009 fiscal year, approved the management-sponsored advisory vote to approve executive compensation and approved the shareholder proposal regarding simple majority voting. The other shareholder proposals did not receive the approval of a majority of the outstanding shares of our common stock; as a result, in accordance with our By-laws, these shareholder proposals were not approved. The number of votes cast for or against and the number of abstentions and broker non-votes with respect to each matter voted upon, as applicable, are set forth below.
 
                             
                Broker
   
For
 
Against
 
Abstain
 
Non-Votes
Election of Directors:
                           
Lloyd C. Blankfein
    394,948,844       4,617,289       491,019     *
John H. Bryan
    389,147,946       10,355,659       553,547     *
Gary D. Cohn
    397,284,153       2,172,283       600,716     *
Claes Dahlbäck
    395,410,514       4,119,945       526,693     *
Stephen Friedman
    396,383,586       3,158,960       514,606     *
William W. George
    397,438,183       2,145,578       473,391     *
Rajat K. Gupta
    384,198,605       15,294,846       563,701     *
James A. Johnson
    393,843,955       5,646,878       566,319     *
Lois D. Juliber
    389,240,130       10,312,669       504,353     *
Lakshmi N. Mittal
    306,121,981       92,822,384       1,112,787     *
James J. Schiro
    393,834,365       5,652,578       570,209     *
Ruth J. Simmons
    395,389,257       4,110,867       557,028     *
Ratification of Appointment of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
    395,390,645       4,136,962       529,545     *
Advisory Vote to Approve Executive Compensation
    389,367,961       8,404,183       2,285,008     *
Shareholder Proposal Regarding Cumulative Voting
    97,057,123       238,879,898       971,486     63,148,645
Shareholder Proposal Regarding Simple Majority Vote
    252,805,076       82,985,939       1,117,492     63,148,645
Shareholder Proposal to Amend By-Laws to Provide for a Board Committee on U.S. Economic Security
    6,715,464       323,145,941       7,047,102     63,148,645
Shareholder Proposal Regarding Political Contributions
    74,858,483       198,421,668       63,628,356     63,148,645
 
 
* Not applicable


143


Table of Contents

Item 6:   Exhibits
 
Exhibits:
         
       
 
10.1
    Letter, dated May 12, 2009, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. James J. Schiro.
       
 
12.1
    Statement re: Computation of Ratios of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Ratios of Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.
       
 
15.1
    Letter re: Unaudited Interim Financial Information.
       
 
31.1
    Rule 13a-14(a) Certifications.
       
 
32.1
    Section 1350 Certifications.
       
 
101
    Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Earnings for the three and six months ended June 26, 2009 and May 30, 2008, (ii) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition as of June 26, 2009 and November 28, 2008, (iii) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity for the six months ended June 26, 2009 and year ended November 28, 2008, (iv) Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the six months ended June 26, 2009 and May 30, 2008, (v) Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the three and six months ended June 26, 2009 and May 30, 2008 and (vi) the notes to the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, tagged as blocks of text.*
 
 
As provided in Rule 406T of Regulation S-T, this information is furnished and not filed for purposes of Sections 11 and 12 of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.


144


Table of Contents

 
SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.
 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC.
 
  By: 
/s/  David A. Viniar
Name: David A. Viniar
  Title:  Chief Financial Officer
 
  By: 
/s/  Sarah E. Smith
Name: Sarah E. Smith
  Title:  Principal Accounting Officer
 
Date: August 4, 2009


145